Updates for compiling with Gtk+ 3.0 (--with-x-toolkit=gtk3).
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobbb792d8b9a781d3e1f68e00e5e3e89b3c4c03244
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
50 #include "systime.h"
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
92 #include <unistd.h>
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #endif
98 #ifdef USE_LUCID
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 #ifdef USE_XIM
141 int use_xim = 1;
142 #else
143 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
144 #endif
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
149 start. */
151 static int any_help_event_p;
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window;
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
157 use. */
159 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
173 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
177 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
181 static struct {
182 struct frame *f;
183 int eventtype;
184 } pending_event_wait;
186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
189 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
190 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
202 /* Mouse movement.
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
220 is off. */
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
232 an ordinary motion.
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
236 event. */
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
251 static Time last_user_time;
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
254 events. */
256 #ifdef __STDC__
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258 #else
259 static int input_signal_count;
260 #endif
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
264 static int x_noop_count;
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
271 #ifdef USE_GTK
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
277 #endif
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
282 /* XEmbed implementation. */
284 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
286 enum xembed_info
288 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
291 enum xembed_message
293 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
294 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
295 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
296 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
297 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
298 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
299 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
300 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
302 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
303 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
304 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
305 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
306 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
309 /* Used in x_flush. */
311 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
312 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
313 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
314 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
316 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
317 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
318 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
319 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
320 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
321 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
322 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
323 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
324 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
325 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
326 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
327 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
328 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
329 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
330 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
331 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
332 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
333 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
334 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
335 enum text_cursor_kinds);
337 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
338 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
339 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
340 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
341 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
342 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
343 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
344 enum scroll_bar_part *,
345 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
346 unsigned long *);
347 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
348 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
349 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
350 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
351 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
352 int *, struct input_event *);
353 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
354 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
355 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
358 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
360 static void
361 x_flush (struct frame *f)
363 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
364 connection may be broken. */
365 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
366 return;
368 BLOCK_INPUT;
369 if (f == NULL)
371 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
372 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
373 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
374 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
376 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
377 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
378 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
382 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
383 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
384 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
385 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
386 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
387 performance. */
389 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
392 /***********************************************************************
393 Debugging
394 ***********************************************************************/
396 #if 0
398 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
399 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
401 struct record
403 char *locus;
404 int type;
407 struct record event_record[100];
409 int event_record_index;
411 void
412 record_event (char *locus, int type)
414 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
415 event_record_index = 0;
417 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
418 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
419 event_record_index++;
422 #endif /* 0 */
426 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
428 struct x_display_info *
429 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
431 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
433 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
434 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
435 return dpyinfo;
437 return 0;
440 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
442 void
443 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
445 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
446 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
447 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
448 double alpha = 1.0;
449 double alpha_min = 1.0;
450 unsigned long opac;
452 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
453 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
454 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
455 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
457 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
458 alpha = f->alpha[0];
459 else
460 alpha = f->alpha[1];
462 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
463 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
464 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
465 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
467 if (alpha < 0.0)
468 return;
469 else if (alpha > 1.0)
470 alpha = 1.0;
471 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
472 alpha = alpha_min;
474 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
476 /* return unless necessary */
478 unsigned char *data;
479 Atom actual;
480 int rc, format;
481 unsigned long n, left;
483 x_catch_errors (dpy);
484 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
485 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
486 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
487 &data);
489 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
491 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
492 XFree ((void *) data);
493 if (value == opac)
495 x_uncatch_errors ();
496 return;
501 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
503 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
504 x_uncatch_errors ();
508 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
510 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
514 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
516 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
520 /***********************************************************************
521 Starting and ending an update
522 ***********************************************************************/
524 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
525 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
526 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
527 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
528 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
530 static void
531 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
533 /* Nothing to do. */
537 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
538 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
539 position of W. */
541 static void
542 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
544 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
545 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
547 updated_window = w;
548 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
550 BLOCK_INPUT;
552 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
554 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
555 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
557 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
558 highlighting. */
559 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
560 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
563 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
567 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
569 static void
570 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
572 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
573 struct face *face;
575 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
576 if (face)
577 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
578 face->foreground);
580 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
581 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
584 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
586 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
587 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
589 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
590 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
591 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
593 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
594 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
595 here. */
597 static void
598 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
600 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
602 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
604 BLOCK_INPUT;
606 if (cursor_on_p)
607 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
608 output_cursor.vpos,
609 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
611 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
612 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
614 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
617 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
618 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
619 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
621 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
622 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
623 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
626 updated_window = NULL;
630 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
631 update_end. */
633 static void
634 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
636 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
637 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
639 #ifndef XFlush
640 BLOCK_INPUT;
641 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
642 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
643 #endif
647 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
648 complete update has been performed. The global variable
649 updated_window is not available here. */
651 static void
652 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
654 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
656 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
658 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
659 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
661 BLOCK_INPUT;
662 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
663 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
664 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
665 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
666 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
667 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
673 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
674 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
675 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
676 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
677 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
678 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
680 static void
681 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
683 struct window *w = updated_window;
684 struct frame *f;
685 int width, height;
687 xassert (w);
689 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
690 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
692 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
693 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
694 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
695 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
696 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
697 overhead is very small. */
698 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
699 && desired_row->full_width_p
700 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
701 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
702 width != 0)
703 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
704 height > 0))
706 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
708 BLOCK_INPUT;
709 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
710 0, y, width, height, False);
711 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
712 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
713 y, width, height, False);
714 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
718 static void
719 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
721 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
722 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
723 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
724 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
725 struct face *face = p->face;
727 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
728 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
730 if (!p->overlay_p)
732 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
734 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
735 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
736 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
737 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
738 if (face->stipple)
739 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
740 else
741 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
743 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
744 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
745 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
746 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
747 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
748 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
749 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
750 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
752 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
754 if (sb_width > 0)
756 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
757 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
758 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
760 if (bx < 0)
762 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
763 if (left + width == p->x)
764 bx = left + sb_width;
765 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
766 bx = left;
767 if (bx >= 0)
769 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
771 nx = width - sb_width;
772 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
773 row->y));
774 ny = row->visible_height;
777 else
779 if (left + width == bx)
781 bx = left + sb_width;
782 nx += width - sb_width;
784 else if (bx + nx == left)
785 nx += width - sb_width;
789 #endif
790 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
791 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
793 if (!face->stipple)
794 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
797 if (p->which)
799 char *bits;
800 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
801 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
802 XGCValues gcv;
804 if (p->wd > 8)
805 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
806 else
807 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
809 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
810 by the server. */
811 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
812 (p->cursor_p
813 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
814 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
815 : face->foreground),
816 face->background, depth);
818 if (p->overlay_p)
820 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
821 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
822 bits, p->wd, p->h,
823 1, 0, 1);
824 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
825 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
826 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
827 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
830 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
831 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
832 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
834 if (p->overlay_p)
836 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
837 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
838 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
842 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
847 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
848 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
849 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
850 rarely happens). */
852 static void
853 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
857 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
858 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
860 static void
861 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
866 /***********************************************************************
867 Glyph display
868 ***********************************************************************/
872 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
873 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
874 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
875 int);
876 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
878 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
884 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
885 unsigned long *, double, int);
886 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
887 double, int, unsigned long);
888 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
889 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
891 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
892 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
893 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
894 int, int, int);
895 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
896 int, int, int, int, int, int,
897 XRectangle *);
898 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
899 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
900 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
902 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
903 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
904 #endif
907 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
908 face. */
910 static void
911 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
913 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
914 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
915 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
916 && !s->cmp)
917 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
918 else
920 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
921 XGCValues xgcv;
922 unsigned long mask;
924 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
925 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
927 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
928 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
930 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
931 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
935 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
936 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
937 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
939 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
940 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
943 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
944 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
945 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
947 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
948 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
949 mask, &xgcv);
950 else
951 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
952 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
954 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
959 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
961 static void
962 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
964 int face_id;
965 struct face *face;
967 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
968 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
969 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
970 if (face == NULL)
971 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
973 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
974 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
975 else
976 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
977 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
978 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
980 if (s->font == s->face->font)
981 s->gc = s->face->gc;
982 else
984 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
985 except for FONT. */
986 XGCValues xgcv;
987 unsigned long mask;
989 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
990 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
991 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
992 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
994 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
995 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
996 mask, &xgcv);
997 else
998 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
999 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1001 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1004 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1008 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1009 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1010 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1012 static INLINE void
1013 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1015 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1019 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1020 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1021 pattern. */
1023 static INLINE void
1024 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1026 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1028 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1030 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1031 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1033 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1035 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1036 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1038 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1040 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1041 s->stippled_p = 0;
1043 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1045 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1046 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1048 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1049 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1051 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1052 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1054 else
1056 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1057 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1060 /* GC must have been set. */
1061 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1065 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1066 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1068 static INLINE void
1069 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1071 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1072 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1074 if (n > 0)
1075 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1076 s->num_clips = n;
1080 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1081 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1082 the area of SRC. */
1084 static void
1085 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1087 XRectangle r;
1089 r.x = src->x;
1090 r.width = src->width;
1091 r.y = src->y;
1092 r.height = src->height;
1093 dst->clip[0] = r;
1094 dst->num_clips = 1;
1095 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1099 /* RIF:
1100 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1102 static void
1103 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1105 if (s->cmp == NULL
1106 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1107 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1109 struct font_metrics metrics;
1111 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1113 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1114 struct font *font = s->font;
1115 int i;
1117 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1118 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1119 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1121 else
1123 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1125 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1127 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1128 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1129 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1131 else if (s->cmp)
1133 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1134 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1139 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1141 static INLINE void
1142 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1144 XGCValues xgcv;
1145 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1146 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1147 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1148 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1152 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1153 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1154 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1155 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1156 contains the first component of a composition. */
1158 static void
1159 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1161 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1162 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1163 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1165 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1167 if (s->stippled_p)
1169 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1170 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1171 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1172 s->y + box_line_width,
1173 s->background_width,
1174 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1175 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1176 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1178 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1179 || s->font_not_found_p
1180 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1181 || force_p)
1183 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1184 s->background_width,
1185 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1186 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1192 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1194 static void
1195 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1197 int i, x;
1199 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1200 of S to the right of that box line. */
1201 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1202 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1203 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1204 else
1205 x = s->x;
1207 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1208 loaded. */
1209 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1211 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1213 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1214 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1215 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1216 s->height - 1);
1217 x += g->pixel_width;
1220 else
1222 struct font *font = s->font;
1223 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1224 int y;
1226 if (font->vertical_centering)
1227 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1229 y = s->ybase - boff;
1230 if (s->for_overlaps
1231 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1232 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1233 else
1234 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1235 if (s->face->overstrike)
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1240 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1242 static void
1243 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1245 int i, j, x;
1246 struct font *font = s->font;
1248 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1249 of S to the right of that box line. */
1250 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1251 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1252 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1253 else
1254 x = s->x;
1256 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1257 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1258 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1259 this composition. */
1261 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1262 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1263 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1265 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1266 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1267 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1269 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1271 int y = s->ybase;
1273 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1274 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1276 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1277 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1279 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1280 if (s->face->overstrike)
1281 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1284 else
1286 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1287 Lisp_Object glyph;
1288 int y = s->ybase;
1289 int width = 0;
1291 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1293 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1294 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1295 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1296 else
1298 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1300 if (j < i)
1302 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1303 if (s->face->overstrike)
1304 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1305 x += width;
1307 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1308 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1309 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1310 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1311 if (s->face->overstrike)
1312 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1313 x += wadjust;
1314 j = i + 1;
1315 width = 0;
1318 if (j < i)
1320 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1321 if (s->face->overstrike)
1322 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1328 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1330 static void
1331 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1333 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1334 XChar2b char2b[8];
1335 int x, i, j;
1337 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1338 of S to the right of that box line. */
1339 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1340 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1341 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1342 else
1343 x = s->x;
1345 s->char2b = char2b;
1347 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1349 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1350 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1352 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1354 if (len > 0
1355 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1356 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1357 >= 1))
1359 Lisp_Object acronym
1360 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1361 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1362 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1363 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1364 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1365 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1368 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1370 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1371 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1372 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1373 str = buf;
1376 if (str)
1378 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1379 unsigned code;
1381 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1382 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1384 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1385 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1387 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1388 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1389 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1391 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1392 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1393 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1396 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1397 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1398 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1399 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1400 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1401 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1405 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1407 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1408 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1409 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1410 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1411 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1414 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1415 cannot be determined. */
1417 static struct frame *
1418 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1420 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1421 Lisp_Object tail;
1422 struct frame *f;
1424 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1426 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1427 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1428 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1429 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1430 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1431 widget = XtParent (widget);
1433 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1434 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1435 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1436 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1437 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1438 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1439 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1440 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1441 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1442 return f;
1444 abort ();
1448 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1449 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1450 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1451 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1454 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1456 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1457 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1461 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1462 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1463 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1464 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1465 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1466 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1469 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1470 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1472 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1473 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1477 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1478 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1480 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1482 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1483 sizeof (Screen *)},
1484 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1485 sizeof (Colormap)}
1489 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1490 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1492 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1495 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1497 DPY is the display we are working on.
1499 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1500 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1501 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1502 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1504 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1505 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1507 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1508 we allocated the color or not.
1510 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1512 static Boolean
1513 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1514 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1515 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1517 Screen *screen;
1518 Colormap cmap;
1519 Pixel pixel;
1520 String color_name;
1521 XColor color;
1523 if (*nargs != 2)
1525 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1526 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1527 "XtToolkitError",
1528 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1529 return False;
1532 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1533 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1534 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1536 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1538 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1539 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1541 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1543 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1544 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1546 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1547 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1549 pixel = color.pixel;
1550 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1552 else
1554 String params[1];
1555 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1557 params[0] = color_name;
1558 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1559 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1560 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1561 params, &nparams);
1562 return False;
1565 if (to->addr != NULL)
1567 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1569 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1570 return False;
1573 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1575 else
1577 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1578 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1581 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1582 return True;
1586 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1587 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1588 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1590 APP is the application context in which we work.
1592 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1593 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1594 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1596 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1598 static void
1599 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1600 Cardinal *nargs)
1602 if (*nargs != 2)
1604 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1605 "XtToolkitError",
1606 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1607 NULL, NULL);
1609 else if (closure != NULL)
1611 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1612 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1613 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1614 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1615 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1620 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1623 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1624 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1625 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1626 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1628 static const XColor *
1629 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1631 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1633 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1635 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1636 int i;
1638 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1639 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1640 dpyinfo->color_cells
1641 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1642 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1644 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1645 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1647 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1648 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1651 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1652 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1656 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1657 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1659 void
1660 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1662 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1664 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1666 int i;
1667 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1669 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1670 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1671 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1672 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1675 else
1676 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1680 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1681 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1683 void
1684 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1686 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1690 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1691 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1692 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1693 allocated. */
1695 static int
1696 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1698 int rc;
1700 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1701 if (rc == 0)
1703 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1704 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1705 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1706 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1707 int nearest, i;
1708 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~ (unsigned long) 0;
1709 int ncells;
1710 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1712 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1714 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1715 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1716 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1717 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1719 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1721 nearest = i;
1722 nearest_delta = delta;
1726 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1727 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1728 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1729 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1731 else
1733 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1734 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1735 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1736 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1737 XColor *cached_color;
1739 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1740 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1741 (cached_color->red != color->red
1742 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1743 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1745 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1746 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1747 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1751 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1752 if (rc)
1753 register_color (color->pixel);
1754 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1756 return rc;
1760 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1761 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1762 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1763 allocated. */
1766 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1768 gamma_correct (f, color);
1769 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1773 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1774 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1775 get color reference counts right. */
1777 unsigned long
1778 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1780 XColor color;
1782 color.pixel = pixel;
1783 BLOCK_INPUT;
1784 x_query_color (f, &color);
1785 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1786 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1787 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1788 register_color (pixel);
1789 #endif
1790 return color.pixel;
1794 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1795 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1796 get color reference counts right. */
1798 unsigned long
1799 x_copy_dpy_color (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int pixel)
1801 XColor color;
1803 color.pixel = pixel;
1804 BLOCK_INPUT;
1805 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1806 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1807 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1808 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1809 register_color (pixel);
1810 #endif
1811 return color.pixel;
1815 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1816 boosted.
1818 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1819 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1820 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1821 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1822 use an additional additive factor.
1824 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1825 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1826 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1829 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1830 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1831 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1832 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1833 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1834 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1836 static int
1837 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1839 XColor color, new;
1840 long bright;
1841 int success_p;
1843 /* Get RGB color values. */
1844 color.pixel = *pixel;
1845 x_query_color (f, &color);
1847 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1848 xassert (factor >= 0);
1849 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1850 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1851 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1853 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1854 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1856 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1857 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1858 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1859 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1860 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1862 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1863 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1864 /* The additive adjustment. */
1865 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1867 if (factor < 1)
1869 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1870 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1871 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1873 else
1875 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1876 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1877 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1881 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1882 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1883 if (success_p)
1885 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1887 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1888 delta to the RGB values. */
1889 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1891 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1892 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1893 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1894 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1896 else
1897 success_p = 1;
1898 *pixel = new.pixel;
1901 return success_p;
1905 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1906 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1907 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1908 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1909 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1910 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1912 static void
1913 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1915 XGCValues xgcv;
1916 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1917 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1918 unsigned long pixel;
1919 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1920 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1921 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1922 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1924 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1925 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1927 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1928 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1929 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1930 if (relief->gc
1931 && relief->allocated_p)
1933 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1934 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1937 /* Allocate new color. */
1938 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1939 pixel = background;
1940 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1941 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1943 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1944 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1947 if (relief->gc == 0)
1949 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1950 mask |= GCStipple;
1951 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1953 else
1954 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1958 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1960 static void
1961 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1963 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1964 unsigned long color;
1966 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1967 color = s->face->box_color;
1968 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1969 && s->img->pixmap
1970 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1971 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1972 else
1974 XGCValues xgcv;
1976 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1977 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1978 color = xgcv.background;
1981 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1982 || color != di->relief_background)
1984 di->relief_background = color;
1985 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1986 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1987 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1988 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1993 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1994 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1995 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1996 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1997 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1998 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1999 when drawing. */
2001 static void
2002 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2003 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2004 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2005 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2007 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2008 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2009 int i;
2010 GC gc;
2012 if (raised_p)
2013 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2014 else
2015 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2016 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2018 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2019 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2020 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2021 corner pixels. */
2023 /* Top. */
2024 if (top_p)
2026 if (width == 1)
2027 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2028 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2029 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2031 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2032 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2033 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2034 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2037 /* Left. */
2038 if (left_p)
2040 if (width == 1)
2041 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2043 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2044 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2046 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2047 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2048 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2051 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2052 if (raised_p)
2053 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2054 else
2055 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2056 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2058 if (width > 1)
2060 /* Outermost top line. */
2061 if (top_p)
2062 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2063 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2064 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2066 /* Outermost left line. */
2067 if (left_p)
2068 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2071 /* Bottom. */
2072 if (bot_p)
2074 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2075 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2076 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2077 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2078 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2079 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2080 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2083 /* Right. */
2084 if (right_p)
2086 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2087 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2088 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2089 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2090 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2093 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2097 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2098 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2099 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2100 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2101 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2102 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2104 static void
2105 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2106 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2107 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2109 XGCValues xgcv;
2111 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2112 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2113 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2115 /* Top. */
2116 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2117 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2119 /* Left. */
2120 if (left_p)
2121 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2122 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2124 /* Bottom. */
2125 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2126 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2128 /* Right. */
2129 if (right_p)
2130 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2131 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2133 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2134 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2138 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2140 static void
2141 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2143 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2144 int left_p, right_p;
2145 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2146 XRectangle clip_rect;
2148 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2149 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2150 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2152 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2153 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2154 ? s->first_glyph
2155 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2157 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2158 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2159 left_x = s->x;
2160 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2161 ? last_x - 1
2162 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2163 top_y = s->y;
2164 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2166 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2167 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2168 && (s->prev == NULL
2169 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2170 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2171 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2172 && (s->next == NULL
2173 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2175 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2177 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2178 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2179 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2180 else
2182 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2183 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2184 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2189 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2191 static void
2192 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2194 int x = s->x;
2195 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2197 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2198 right of that line. */
2199 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2200 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2201 && s->slice.x == 0)
2202 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2204 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2205 by that margin. */
2206 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2207 x += s->img->hmargin;
2208 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2209 y += s->img->vmargin;
2211 if (s->img->pixmap)
2213 if (s->img->mask)
2215 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2216 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2217 trust on the shape extension to be available
2218 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2219 manually. */
2220 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2221 | GCFunction);
2222 XGCValues xgcv;
2223 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2225 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2226 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2227 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2228 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2229 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2231 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2232 image_rect.x = x;
2233 image_rect.y = y;
2234 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2235 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2236 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2237 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2238 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2239 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2241 else
2243 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2245 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2246 image_rect.x = x;
2247 image_rect.y = y;
2248 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2249 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2250 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2251 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2252 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2253 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2255 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2256 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2257 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2258 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2259 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2260 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2261 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2263 int r = s->img->relief;
2264 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2265 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2266 x - r, y - r,
2267 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2268 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2272 else
2273 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2274 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2275 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2279 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2281 static void
2282 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2284 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2285 XRectangle r;
2286 int x = s->x;
2287 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2289 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2290 right of that line. */
2291 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2292 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2293 && s->slice.x == 0)
2294 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2296 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2297 by that margin. */
2298 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2299 x += s->img->hmargin;
2300 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2301 y += s->img->vmargin;
2303 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2304 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2306 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2307 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2309 else
2311 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2312 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2315 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2316 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2318 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2319 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2320 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2321 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2323 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2324 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2325 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2326 s->slice.y == 0,
2327 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2328 s->slice.x == 0,
2329 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2330 &r);
2334 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2336 static void
2337 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2339 int x = 0;
2340 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2342 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2343 right of that line. */
2344 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2345 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2346 && s->slice.x == 0)
2347 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2349 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2350 by that margin. */
2351 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2352 x += s->img->hmargin;
2353 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2354 y += s->img->vmargin;
2356 if (s->img->pixmap)
2358 if (s->img->mask)
2360 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2361 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2362 trust on the shape extension to be available
2363 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2364 manually. */
2365 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2366 | GCFunction);
2367 XGCValues xgcv;
2369 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2370 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2371 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2372 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2373 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2375 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2376 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2377 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2378 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2380 else
2382 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2383 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2384 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2386 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2387 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2388 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2389 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2390 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2391 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2392 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2394 int r = s->img->relief;
2395 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2396 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2397 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2398 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2402 else
2403 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2404 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2405 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2409 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2410 give the rectangle to draw. */
2412 static void
2413 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2415 if (s->stippled_p)
2417 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2418 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2419 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2420 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2422 else
2423 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2427 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2429 s->y
2430 s->x +-------------------------
2431 | s->face->box
2433 | +-------------------------
2434 | | s->img->margin
2436 | | +-------------------
2437 | | | the image
2441 static void
2442 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2444 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2445 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2446 int height;
2447 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2449 height = s->height;
2450 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2451 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2452 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2453 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2455 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2456 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2457 flickering. */
2458 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2459 if (height > s->slice.height
2460 || s->img->hmargin
2461 || s->img->vmargin
2462 || s->img->mask
2463 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2464 || s->width != s->background_width)
2466 if (s->img->mask)
2468 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2469 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2470 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2471 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2472 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2474 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2475 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2476 s->background_width,
2477 s->height, depth);
2479 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2480 pixmap. */
2481 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2483 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2484 if (s->stippled_p)
2486 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2487 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2488 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2492 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2494 else
2496 XGCValues xgcv;
2497 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2498 &xgcv);
2499 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2500 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2501 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2502 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2505 else
2507 int x = s->x;
2508 int y = s->y;
2510 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2511 && s->slice.x == 0)
2512 x += box_line_hwidth;
2514 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2515 y += box_line_vwidth;
2517 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2520 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2523 /* Draw the foreground. */
2524 if (pixmap != None)
2526 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2527 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2528 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2529 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2530 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2532 else
2533 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2535 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2536 if (s->img->relief
2537 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2538 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2539 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2543 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2545 static void
2546 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2548 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2550 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2551 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2553 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2554 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2555 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2556 int x = s->x;
2558 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2560 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2562 if (x < left_x)
2564 background_width -= left_x - x;
2565 x = left_x;
2568 else
2570 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2571 stretch glyph. */
2572 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2574 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2575 background_width -= x - right_x;
2576 x += background_width;
2578 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2579 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2580 x -= width;
2582 /* Draw cursor. */
2583 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2585 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2586 if (width < background_width)
2588 int y = s->y;
2589 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2590 XRectangle r;
2591 GC gc;
2593 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2594 x += width;
2595 else
2596 x = s->x;
2597 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2598 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2600 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2601 gc = s->gc;
2603 else
2604 gc = s->face->gc;
2606 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2607 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2609 if (s->face->stipple)
2611 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2612 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2613 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2614 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2616 else
2618 XGCValues xgcv;
2619 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2620 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2621 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2622 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2626 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2628 int background_width = s->background_width;
2629 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2631 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2632 except for header line and mode line. */
2633 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2635 background_width -= left_x - x;
2636 x = left_x;
2638 if (background_width > 0)
2639 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2642 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2646 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2648 static void
2649 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2651 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2653 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2654 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2655 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2656 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2658 int width;
2659 struct glyph_string *next;
2661 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2662 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2663 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2664 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2666 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2667 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2668 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2669 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2670 else
2671 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2672 next->num_clips = 0;
2676 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2677 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2679 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2680 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2681 if (!s->for_overlaps
2682 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2683 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2684 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2687 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2688 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2689 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2690 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2691 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2693 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2694 && !s->clip_tail
2695 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2696 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2697 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2698 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2699 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2700 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2701 else
2702 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2704 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2706 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2707 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2708 break;
2710 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2711 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2712 break;
2714 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2715 if (s->for_overlaps)
2716 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2717 else
2718 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2719 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2720 break;
2722 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2723 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2724 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2725 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2726 else
2727 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2728 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2729 break;
2731 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2732 if (s->for_overlaps)
2733 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2734 else
2735 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2736 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2737 break;
2739 default:
2740 abort ();
2743 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2745 /* Draw underline. */
2746 if (s->face->underline_p)
2748 unsigned long thickness, position;
2749 int y;
2751 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2753 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2754 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2755 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2757 else
2759 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2760 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2761 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2762 else
2763 thickness = 1;
2764 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2765 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2766 else
2768 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2769 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2770 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2771 specs, and its default is
2773 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2774 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2776 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2777 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2778 position = s->font->underline_position;
2779 else if (s->font)
2780 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2781 else
2782 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2784 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2786 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2787 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2788 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2789 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2790 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2791 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2792 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2793 s->underline_position = position;
2794 y = s->ybase + position;
2795 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2796 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2797 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2798 else
2800 XGCValues xgcv;
2801 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2802 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2803 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2804 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2805 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2809 /* Draw overline. */
2810 if (s->face->overline_p)
2812 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2814 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2815 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2816 s->width, h);
2817 else
2819 XGCValues xgcv;
2820 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2821 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2822 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2823 s->width, h);
2824 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2828 /* Draw strike-through. */
2829 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2831 unsigned long h = 1;
2832 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2834 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2835 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2836 s->width, h);
2837 else
2839 XGCValues xgcv;
2840 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2841 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2842 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2843 s->width, h);
2844 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2848 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2849 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2850 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2852 if (s->prev)
2854 struct glyph_string *prev;
2856 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2857 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2858 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2860 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2861 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2862 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2864 prev->hl = s->hl;
2865 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2866 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2867 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2868 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2869 else
2870 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2871 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2872 prev->hl = save;
2873 prev->num_clips = 0;
2877 if (s->next)
2879 struct glyph_string *next;
2881 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2882 if (next->hl != s->hl
2883 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2885 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2886 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2887 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2889 next->hl = s->hl;
2890 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2891 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2892 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2893 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2894 else
2895 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2896 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2897 next->hl = save;
2898 next->num_clips = 0;
2903 /* Reset clipping. */
2904 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2905 s->num_clips = 0;
2908 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2910 void
2911 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2913 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2914 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2915 x, y, width, height,
2916 x + shift_by, y);
2919 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2920 for X frames. */
2922 static void
2923 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2925 abort ();
2929 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2930 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2932 void
2933 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2935 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2936 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2940 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2942 static void
2943 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2945 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2946 longer visible. */
2947 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2948 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2949 output_cursor.x = -1;
2951 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2952 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2953 BLOCK_INPUT;
2954 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2956 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2957 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2958 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2960 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2961 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2962 redisplay, do it here. */
2963 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2964 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2965 #endif
2967 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2969 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2974 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2976 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2977 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2979 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2982 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2983 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2985 static int
2986 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2988 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2989 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2990 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2992 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2993 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2994 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2997 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2999 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
3000 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
3001 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
3004 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
3005 positive. */
3006 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
3007 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
3009 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
3010 negative. */
3011 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
3014 void
3015 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3017 BLOCK_INPUT;
3020 #ifdef USE_GTK
3021 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3022 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3023 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3024 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3025 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3026 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3027 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3028 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3029 do { \
3030 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3031 cairo_fill (cr); \
3033 while (0)
3034 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3035 GdkGCValues vals;
3036 GdkGC *gc;
3037 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3038 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3039 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3040 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3041 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3042 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3043 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3044 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3045 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3046 GC gc;
3048 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3049 pixels into background pixels. */
3051 XGCValues values;
3053 values.function = GXxor;
3054 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3055 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3057 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3058 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3060 #endif
3062 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3063 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3064 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3065 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3066 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3067 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3068 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3070 int width;
3072 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3073 edge it is next to. */
3074 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3076 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3077 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3078 break;
3080 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3081 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3082 break;
3084 default:
3085 break;
3088 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3090 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3091 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3093 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3094 flash_left,
3095 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3096 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3097 width, flash_height);
3098 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3099 flash_left,
3100 (height - flash_height
3101 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3102 width, flash_height);
3105 else
3106 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3107 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3108 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3109 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3111 x_flush (f);
3114 struct timeval wakeup;
3116 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3118 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3119 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3120 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3121 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3123 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3124 available. */
3125 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3127 struct timeval current;
3128 struct timeval timeout;
3130 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3132 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3133 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3134 break;
3136 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3137 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3138 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3140 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3141 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3145 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3146 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3148 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3149 flash_left,
3150 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3151 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3152 width, flash_height);
3153 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3154 flash_left,
3155 (height - flash_height
3156 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3157 width, flash_height);
3159 else
3160 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3161 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3162 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3163 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3165 #ifdef USE_GTK
3166 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3167 cairo_destroy (cr);
3168 #else
3169 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3170 #endif
3171 #undef XFillRectangle
3172 #else
3173 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3174 #endif
3175 x_flush (f);
3179 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3182 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3185 static void
3186 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3188 BLOCK_INPUT;
3189 if (invisible)
3191 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3192 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3193 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3195 else
3196 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3197 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3198 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3199 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3203 /* Make audible bell. */
3205 void
3206 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3208 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3210 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3211 if (visible_bell)
3212 XTflash (f);
3213 else
3214 #endif
3216 BLOCK_INPUT;
3217 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3218 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3219 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3225 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3226 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3227 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3228 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3230 static void
3231 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3233 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3238 /***********************************************************************
3239 Line Dance
3240 ***********************************************************************/
3242 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3243 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3245 static void
3246 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3248 abort ();
3252 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3254 static void
3255 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3257 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3258 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3260 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3261 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3262 fringe of W. */
3263 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3265 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3266 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3267 bottom_y = y + height;
3269 if (to_y < from_y)
3271 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3272 line at the bottom. */
3273 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3274 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3275 else
3276 height = run->height;
3278 else
3280 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3281 at the bottom. */
3282 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3283 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3284 else
3285 height = run->height;
3288 BLOCK_INPUT;
3290 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3291 updated_window = w;
3292 x_clear_cursor (w);
3294 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3295 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3296 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3297 x, from_y,
3298 width, height,
3299 x, to_y);
3301 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3306 /***********************************************************************
3307 Exposure Events
3308 ***********************************************************************/
3311 static void
3312 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3314 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3315 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3316 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3317 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3318 BLOCK_INPUT;
3319 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3320 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3321 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3322 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3323 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3326 static void
3327 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3329 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3330 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3331 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3332 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3333 BLOCK_INPUT;
3334 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3335 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3336 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3337 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3338 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3341 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3342 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3343 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3344 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3345 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3347 static void
3348 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3350 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3352 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3354 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3355 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3356 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3358 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3359 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3361 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3362 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3363 else
3364 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3367 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3370 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3371 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3372 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3374 static void
3375 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3377 if (type == FocusIn)
3379 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3381 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3382 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3384 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3385 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3386 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3387 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3388 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3390 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3391 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3395 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3397 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3398 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3399 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3400 #endif
3402 else if (type == FocusOut)
3404 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3406 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3408 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3409 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3412 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3413 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3414 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3415 #endif
3416 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3417 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3421 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3422 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3424 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3426 static void
3427 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3429 struct frame *frame;
3431 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3432 if (! frame)
3433 return;
3435 switch (event->type)
3437 case EnterNotify:
3438 case LeaveNotify:
3440 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3441 int focus_state
3442 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3444 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3445 && event->xcrossing.focus
3446 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3447 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3448 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3449 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3451 break;
3453 case FocusIn:
3454 case FocusOut:
3455 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3456 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3457 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3458 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3459 break;
3461 case ClientMessage:
3462 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3464 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3465 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3466 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3468 break;
3473 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3475 void
3476 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3478 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3481 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3482 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3483 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3485 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3486 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3487 the appropriate X display info. */
3489 static void
3490 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3492 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3495 static void
3496 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3498 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3500 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3502 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3503 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3504 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3505 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3506 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3508 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3509 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3512 else
3513 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3515 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3517 if (old_highlight)
3518 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3519 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3520 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3526 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3528 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3529 static void
3530 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3532 int min_code, max_code;
3533 KeySym *syms;
3534 int syms_per_code;
3535 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3537 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3538 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3539 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3540 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3541 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3543 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3545 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3546 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3547 &syms_per_code);
3548 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3550 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3551 Alt keysyms are on. */
3553 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3554 int found_alt_or_meta;
3556 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3558 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3559 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3561 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3563 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3564 if (code == 0)
3565 continue;
3567 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3569 int code_col;
3571 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3573 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3575 switch (sym)
3577 case XK_Meta_L:
3578 case XK_Meta_R:
3579 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3580 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3581 break;
3583 case XK_Alt_L:
3584 case XK_Alt_R:
3585 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3586 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3587 break;
3589 case XK_Hyper_L:
3590 case XK_Hyper_R:
3591 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3592 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3593 code_col = syms_per_code;
3594 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3595 break;
3597 case XK_Super_L:
3598 case XK_Super_R:
3599 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3600 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3601 code_col = syms_per_code;
3602 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3603 break;
3605 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3606 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3607 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3608 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3609 code_col = syms_per_code;
3610 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3611 break;
3619 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3620 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3622 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3623 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3626 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3627 make them just meta, not alt. */
3628 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3630 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3633 XFree ((char *) syms);
3634 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3637 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3638 Emacs uses. */
3640 unsigned int
3641 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3643 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3644 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3645 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3646 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3647 Lisp_Object tem;
3649 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3650 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3651 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3652 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3653 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3654 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3655 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3656 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3659 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3660 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3661 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3662 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3663 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3664 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3667 static unsigned int
3668 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3670 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3671 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3672 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3673 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3675 Lisp_Object tem;
3677 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3678 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3679 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3680 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3681 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3682 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3683 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3684 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3687 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3688 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3689 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3690 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3691 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3692 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3695 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3697 char *
3698 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3700 char *value;
3702 BLOCK_INPUT;
3703 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3704 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3706 return value;
3711 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3713 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3715 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3716 the mouse. */
3718 static Lisp_Object
3719 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3721 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3722 otherwise. */
3723 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3724 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3725 result->timestamp = event->time;
3726 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3727 event->state)
3728 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3729 ? up_modifier
3730 : down_modifier));
3732 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3733 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3734 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3735 result->arg = Qnil;
3736 return Qnil;
3740 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3741 The input handler calls this.
3743 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3744 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3745 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3746 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3748 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3749 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3751 static int
3752 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3754 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3755 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3756 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3758 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3759 return 0;
3761 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3763 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3764 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3765 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3766 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3767 return 1;
3771 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3772 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3773 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3774 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3775 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3776 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3778 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3779 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3780 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3781 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3782 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3783 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3784 return 1;
3787 return 0;
3791 /************************************************************************
3792 Mouse Face
3793 ************************************************************************/
3795 static void
3796 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3798 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3799 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3800 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3801 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3802 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3807 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3808 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3810 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3811 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3812 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3813 position on the scroll bar.
3815 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3816 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3817 the mouse is over.
3819 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3820 was at this position.
3822 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3824 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3825 movement. */
3827 static void
3828 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
3830 FRAME_PTR f1;
3832 BLOCK_INPUT;
3834 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3835 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3836 else
3838 Window root;
3839 int root_x, root_y;
3841 Window dummy_window;
3842 int dummy;
3844 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3846 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3847 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3848 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3849 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3850 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3852 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3854 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3855 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3856 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3858 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3859 &root,
3861 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3862 a different screen. */
3863 &dummy_window,
3865 /* The position on that root window. */
3866 &root_x, &root_y,
3868 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3869 &dummy, &dummy,
3871 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3872 we don't care. */
3873 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3875 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3876 containing the pointer. */
3878 Window win, child;
3879 int win_x, win_y;
3880 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3882 win = root;
3884 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3885 structure is changing at the same time this function
3886 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3888 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3890 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3891 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3893 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3894 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3895 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3897 /* From-window, to-window. */
3898 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3900 /* From-position, to-position. */
3901 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3903 /* Child of win. */
3904 &child);
3905 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3907 else
3909 while (1)
3911 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3913 /* From-window, to-window. */
3914 root, win,
3916 /* From-position, to-position. */
3917 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3919 /* Child of win. */
3920 &child);
3922 if (child == None || child == win)
3923 break;
3924 #ifdef USE_GTK
3925 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3926 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3927 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3928 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3929 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3930 break;
3931 #endif
3932 win = child;
3933 parent_x = win_x;
3934 parent_y = win_y;
3937 /* Now we know that:
3938 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3939 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3940 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3941 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3942 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3943 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3944 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3945 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3946 never use them in that case.) */
3948 #ifdef USE_GTK
3949 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3950 want the edit window. */
3951 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3952 #else
3953 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3954 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3955 #endif
3957 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3958 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3959 on the frame. */
3960 if (f1 != NULL
3961 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3962 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3963 f1 = NULL;
3964 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3967 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3968 f1 = 0;
3970 x_uncatch_errors ();
3972 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3973 if (! f1)
3975 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3977 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3979 if (bar)
3981 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3982 win_x = parent_x;
3983 win_y = parent_y;
3987 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3988 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3990 if (f1)
3992 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3993 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3994 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3995 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3996 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3997 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3998 the frame are divided into. */
4000 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4001 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4003 *bar_window = Qnil;
4004 *part = 0;
4005 *fp = f1;
4006 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4007 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4008 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
4013 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4018 /***********************************************************************
4019 Scroll bars
4020 ***********************************************************************/
4022 /* Scroll bar support. */
4024 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4025 manages it.
4026 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4027 bits. */
4029 static struct scroll_bar *
4030 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4032 Lisp_Object tail;
4034 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4035 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4036 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4038 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4040 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4042 frame = XCAR (tail);
4043 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4044 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4045 abort ();
4047 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4048 continue;
4050 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4051 right window ID. */
4052 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4053 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4054 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4055 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4056 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4057 condemned = Qnil,
4058 ! NILP (bar));
4059 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4060 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4061 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4062 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4065 return 0;
4069 #if defined USE_LUCID
4071 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4072 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4074 static Widget
4075 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4077 Lisp_Object tail;
4079 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4081 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4083 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4084 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4086 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4087 return menu_bar;
4091 return NULL;
4094 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4097 /************************************************************************
4098 Toolkit scroll bars
4099 ************************************************************************/
4101 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4103 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4104 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4105 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4106 struct scroll_bar *);
4107 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4108 int, int, int);
4111 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4112 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4114 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4116 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4118 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4120 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4121 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4123 #ifndef USE_GTK
4124 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4126 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4128 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4130 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4131 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4132 to avoid jerkyness. */
4134 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4136 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4137 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4138 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4139 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4141 static void
4142 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4143 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4145 int scroll_bar_p;
4146 const char *end_action;
4148 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4149 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4150 end_action = "Release";
4151 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4152 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4153 end_action = "EndScroll";
4154 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4156 if (scroll_bar_p
4157 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4158 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4160 struct window *w;
4162 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4163 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4164 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4166 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4168 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4169 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4170 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4172 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4173 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4175 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4176 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4179 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4181 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4182 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4184 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4185 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4188 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4189 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4190 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4191 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4193 static void
4194 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4196 XEvent event;
4197 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4198 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4199 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4200 int i;
4202 BLOCK_INPUT;
4204 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4205 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4206 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4207 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4208 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4209 ev->format = 32;
4211 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4212 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4213 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4214 into that array in the event. */
4215 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4216 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4217 break;
4219 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4221 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4222 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4223 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4225 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4226 nbytes);
4227 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4228 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4231 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4232 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4233 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4234 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4235 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4236 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4238 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4239 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4240 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4241 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4242 #endif
4244 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4245 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4246 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4247 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4248 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4252 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4253 in *IEVENT. */
4255 static void
4256 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4258 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4259 Lisp_Object window;
4260 struct frame *f;
4261 struct window *w;
4263 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4264 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4266 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4267 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4269 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4270 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4271 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4272 #ifdef USE_GTK
4273 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4274 #else
4275 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4276 #endif
4277 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4278 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4279 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4280 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4281 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4285 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4287 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4289 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4292 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4293 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4294 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4296 static void
4297 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4299 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4300 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4301 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4303 switch (cs->reason)
4305 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4306 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4307 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4308 break;
4310 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4311 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4312 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4313 break;
4315 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4316 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4317 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4318 break;
4320 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4321 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4322 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4323 break;
4325 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4326 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4327 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4328 break;
4330 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4331 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4332 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4333 break;
4335 case XmCR_DRAG:
4337 int slider_size;
4339 /* Get the slider size. */
4340 BLOCK_INPUT;
4341 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4342 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4344 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4345 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4346 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4347 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4349 break;
4351 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4352 break;
4355 if (part >= 0)
4357 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4358 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4359 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4363 #elif defined USE_GTK
4365 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4366 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4368 static gboolean
4369 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4370 GtkScrollType scroll,
4371 gdouble value,
4372 gpointer user_data)
4374 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4375 gdouble position;
4376 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4377 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4378 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4380 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4381 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4384 switch (scroll)
4386 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4387 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4388 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4389 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4391 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4392 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4393 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4394 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4395 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4397 break;
4398 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4399 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4400 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4401 break;
4402 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4403 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4404 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4405 break;
4406 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4407 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4408 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4409 break;
4410 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4411 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4412 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4413 break;
4416 if (part >= 0)
4418 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4419 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4420 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4423 return FALSE;
4426 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4428 static gboolean
4429 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4430 GdkEventButton *event,
4431 gpointer user_data)
4433 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4434 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4435 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4437 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4438 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4439 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4442 return FALSE;
4446 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4448 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4449 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4450 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4451 the thumb is. */
4453 static void
4454 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4456 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4457 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4458 float shown;
4459 int whole, portion, height;
4460 int part;
4462 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4463 BLOCK_INPUT;
4464 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4465 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4467 whole = 10000000;
4468 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4470 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4471 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4472 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4473 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4474 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4475 bottom). */
4476 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4477 else
4478 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4480 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4481 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4482 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4483 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4487 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4488 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4489 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4490 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4491 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4492 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4493 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4495 static void
4496 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4498 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4499 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4500 int position = (long) call_data;
4501 Dimension height;
4502 int part;
4504 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4505 BLOCK_INPUT;
4506 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4507 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4509 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4510 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4512 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4513 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4514 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4515 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4516 else
4517 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4519 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4520 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4521 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4522 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4525 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4527 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4529 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4530 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4532 #ifdef USE_GTK
4533 static void
4534 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4536 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4538 BLOCK_INPUT;
4539 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4540 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4541 scroll_bar_name);
4542 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4545 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4547 static void
4548 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4550 Window xwindow;
4551 Widget widget;
4552 Arg av[20];
4553 int ac = 0;
4554 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4555 unsigned long pixel;
4557 BLOCK_INPUT;
4559 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4560 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4561 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4562 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4563 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4564 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4565 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4566 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4567 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4569 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4570 if (pixel != -1)
4572 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4573 ++ac;
4576 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4577 if (pixel != -1)
4579 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4580 ++ac;
4583 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4584 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4586 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4587 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4588 (XtPointer) bar);
4589 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4590 (XtPointer) bar);
4591 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4592 (XtPointer) bar);
4593 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4594 (XtPointer) bar);
4595 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4596 (XtPointer) bar);
4597 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4598 (XtPointer) bar);
4599 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4600 (XtPointer) bar);
4602 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4603 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4605 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4606 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4607 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4608 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4610 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4612 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4613 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4614 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4615 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4616 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4617 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4618 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4619 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4621 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4622 if (pixel != -1)
4624 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4625 ++ac;
4628 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4629 if (pixel != -1)
4631 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4632 ++ac;
4635 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4637 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4638 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4640 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4641 if (pixel != -1)
4643 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4644 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4645 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4646 pixel = -1;
4647 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4650 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4652 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4653 if (pixel != -1)
4655 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4656 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4657 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4658 pixel = -1;
4659 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4663 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4664 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4665 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4666 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4667 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4668 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4669 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4670 colors itself. */
4672 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4673 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4674 ++ac;
4676 else
4677 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4678 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4679 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4681 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4682 the shadows. */
4683 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4684 ++ac;
4686 /* Specify the colors. */
4687 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4688 if (pixel != -1)
4690 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4691 ++ac;
4693 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4694 if (pixel != -1)
4696 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4697 ++ac;
4700 #endif
4702 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4703 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4706 char *initial = "";
4707 char *val = initial;
4708 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4709 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4710 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4711 #endif
4712 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4713 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4714 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4715 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4716 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4717 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4721 /* Define callbacks. */
4722 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4723 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4724 (XtPointer) bar);
4726 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4727 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4729 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4731 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4732 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4733 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4734 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4736 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4737 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4738 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4739 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4741 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4743 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4746 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4747 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4749 #ifdef USE_GTK
4750 static void
4751 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4753 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4756 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4757 static void
4758 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4759 int whole)
4761 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4762 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4763 float top, shown;
4765 BLOCK_INPUT;
4767 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4769 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4770 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4771 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4772 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4773 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4774 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4775 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4776 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4777 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4778 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4779 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4780 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4781 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4782 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4783 whole += portion;
4785 if (whole <= 0)
4786 top = 0, shown = 1;
4787 else
4789 top = (float) position / whole;
4790 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4793 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4795 int size, value;
4797 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4798 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4799 value. */
4800 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4801 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4802 size = max (size, 1);
4804 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4805 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4806 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4808 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4810 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4812 if (whole == 0)
4813 top = 0, shown = 1;
4814 else
4816 top = (float) position / whole;
4817 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4821 float old_top, old_shown;
4822 Dimension height;
4823 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4824 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4825 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4826 XtNheight, &height,
4827 NULL);
4829 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4830 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4831 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4832 else
4833 top = old_top;
4834 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4835 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4837 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4838 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4839 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4840 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4842 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4843 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4844 else
4846 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4847 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4848 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4850 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4854 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4856 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4858 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4860 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4864 /************************************************************************
4865 Scroll bars, general
4866 ************************************************************************/
4868 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4869 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4870 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4871 scroll bar. */
4873 static struct scroll_bar *
4874 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4876 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4877 struct scroll_bar *bar
4878 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4880 BLOCK_INPUT;
4882 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4883 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4884 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4886 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4887 unsigned long mask;
4888 Window window;
4890 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4891 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4892 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4894 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4895 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4896 | ExposureMask);
4897 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4899 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4901 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4902 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4903 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4904 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4905 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4906 left, top, width,
4907 window_box_height (w), False);
4909 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4910 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4911 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4912 top,
4913 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4914 height,
4915 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4917 CopyFromParent,
4918 CopyFromParent,
4919 CopyFromParent,
4920 /* Attributes. */
4921 mask, &a);
4922 bar->x_window = window;
4924 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4926 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4927 bar->top = top;
4928 bar->left = left;
4929 bar->width = width;
4930 bar->height = height;
4931 bar->start = 0;
4932 bar->end = 0;
4933 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4934 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4936 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4937 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4938 bar->prev = Qnil;
4939 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4940 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4941 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4943 /* Map the window/widget. */
4944 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4946 #ifdef USE_GTK
4947 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4948 bar->x_window,
4949 top,
4950 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4951 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4952 max (height, 1));
4953 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4954 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4955 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4956 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4957 top,
4958 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4959 max (height, 1), 0);
4960 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4961 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4963 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4964 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4965 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4967 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4968 return bar;
4972 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4974 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4976 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4977 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4978 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4979 events.)
4981 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4982 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4983 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4984 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4985 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4987 static void
4988 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4990 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4991 Window w = bar->x_window;
4992 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4993 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4995 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4996 if (! rebuild
4997 && start == bar->start
4998 && end == bar->end)
4999 return;
5001 BLOCK_INPUT;
5004 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5005 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5006 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5008 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5009 the distance between start and end. */
5011 int length = end - start;
5013 if (start < 0)
5014 start = 0;
5015 else if (start > top_range)
5016 start = top_range;
5017 end = start + length;
5019 if (end < start)
5020 end = start;
5021 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5022 end = top_range;
5025 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5026 bar->start = start;
5027 bar->end = end;
5029 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5030 if (end > top_range)
5031 end = top_range;
5033 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5034 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5035 that many pixels tall. */
5036 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5038 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5039 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5040 if (0 < start)
5041 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5042 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5043 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5044 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5045 inside_width, start,
5046 False);
5048 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5049 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5050 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5051 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5053 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5054 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5055 /* x, y, width, height */
5056 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5057 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5058 inside_width, end - start);
5060 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5061 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5062 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5063 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5065 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5066 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5067 if (end < inside_height)
5068 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5069 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5070 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5071 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5072 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5073 False);
5077 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5080 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5082 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5083 nil. */
5085 static void
5086 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5088 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5089 BLOCK_INPUT;
5091 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5092 #ifdef USE_GTK
5093 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5094 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5095 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5096 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5097 #else
5098 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5099 #endif
5101 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5102 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5104 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5108 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5109 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5110 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5111 create one. */
5113 static void
5114 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5116 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5117 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5118 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5119 int window_y, window_height;
5120 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5121 int fringe_extended_p;
5122 #endif
5124 /* Get window dimensions. */
5125 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5126 top = window_y;
5127 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5128 height = window_height;
5130 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5131 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5133 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5134 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5135 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5136 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5137 else
5138 sb_width = width;
5140 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5141 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5142 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5143 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5144 else
5145 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5146 #else
5147 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5148 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5149 else
5150 sb_left = left;
5151 #endif
5153 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5154 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5155 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5156 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5157 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5158 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5159 else
5160 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5161 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5162 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5163 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5164 #endif
5166 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5167 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5169 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5171 BLOCK_INPUT;
5172 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5173 if (fringe_extended_p)
5174 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5175 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5176 else
5177 #endif
5178 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5179 left, top, width, height, False);
5180 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5183 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5185 else
5187 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5188 unsigned int mask = 0;
5190 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5192 BLOCK_INPUT;
5194 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5195 mask |= CWX;
5196 if (top != bar->top)
5197 mask |= CWY;
5198 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5199 mask |= CWWidth;
5200 if (height != bar->height)
5201 mask |= CWHeight;
5203 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5205 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5206 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5208 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5209 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5210 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5212 if (fringe_extended_p)
5213 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5214 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5215 else
5216 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5217 left, top, width, height, False);
5219 #ifdef USE_GTK
5220 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5221 bar->x_window,
5222 top,
5223 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5224 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5225 max (height, 1));
5226 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5227 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5228 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5229 top,
5230 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5231 max (height, 1), 0);
5232 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5234 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5236 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5237 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5238 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5240 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5241 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5242 height, False);
5243 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5244 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5245 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5246 height, False);
5249 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5250 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5251 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5252 example. */
5254 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5255 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5256 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5258 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5259 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5260 left + area_width - rest, top,
5261 rest, height, False);
5262 else
5263 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5264 left, top, rest, height, False);
5268 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5269 if (mask)
5271 XWindowChanges wc;
5273 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5274 wc.y = top;
5275 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5276 wc.height = height;
5277 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5278 mask, &wc);
5281 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5283 /* Remember new settings. */
5284 bar->left = sb_left;
5285 bar->top = top;
5286 bar->width = sb_width;
5287 bar->height = height;
5289 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5292 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5293 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5295 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5296 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5297 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5298 dragged. */
5299 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5301 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5303 if (whole == 0)
5304 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5305 else
5307 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5308 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5309 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5312 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5314 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5318 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5319 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5320 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5321 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5322 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5323 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5324 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5326 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5327 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5328 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5330 static void
5331 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5333 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5334 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5336 Lisp_Object bar;
5337 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5338 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5339 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5340 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5341 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5342 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5343 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5348 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5349 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5351 static void
5352 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5354 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5355 struct frame *f;
5357 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5358 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5359 abort ();
5361 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5363 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5364 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5365 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5367 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5368 the lists. */
5369 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5370 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5371 return;
5372 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5373 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5374 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5375 else
5376 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5377 one or the other! */
5378 abort ();
5380 else
5381 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5383 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5384 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5386 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5387 bar->prev = Qnil;
5388 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5389 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5390 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5393 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5394 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5396 static void
5397 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5399 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5401 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5403 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5404 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5405 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5407 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5409 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5411 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5413 next = b->next;
5414 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5417 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5418 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5422 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5423 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5424 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5426 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5427 mark bits. */
5429 static void
5430 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5432 Window w = bar->x_window;
5433 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5434 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5435 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5437 BLOCK_INPUT;
5439 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5441 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5442 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5443 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5444 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5446 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5447 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5449 /* x, y, width, height */
5450 0, 0,
5451 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5452 bar->height - 1);
5454 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5455 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5456 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5457 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5459 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5462 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5464 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5465 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5467 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5468 mark bits. */
5471 static void
5472 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5474 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5475 abort ();
5477 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5478 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5479 emacs_event->modifiers
5480 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5481 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5482 event->xbutton.state)
5483 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5484 ? up_modifier
5485 : down_modifier));
5486 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5487 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5488 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5490 int top_range
5491 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5492 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5494 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5495 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5497 if (y < bar->start)
5498 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5499 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5500 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5501 else
5502 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5504 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5505 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5506 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5507 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5509 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5510 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5512 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5513 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5515 #endif
5517 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5518 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5522 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5524 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5526 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5527 mark bits. */
5529 static void
5530 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5532 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5534 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5536 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5537 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5539 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5540 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5542 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5543 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5545 if (new_start != bar->start)
5547 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5549 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5554 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5556 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5557 on the scroll bar. */
5559 static void
5560 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
5562 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5563 Window w = bar->x_window;
5564 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5565 int win_x, win_y;
5566 Window dummy_window;
5567 int dummy_coord;
5568 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5570 BLOCK_INPUT;
5572 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5573 report that. */
5574 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5576 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5577 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5578 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5580 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5581 &win_x, &win_y,
5583 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5584 &dummy_mask))
5586 else
5588 int top_range
5589 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5591 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5593 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5594 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5596 if (win_y < 0)
5597 win_y = 0;
5598 if (win_y > top_range)
5599 win_y = top_range;
5601 *fp = f;
5602 *bar_window = bar->window;
5604 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5605 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5606 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5607 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5608 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5609 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5610 else
5611 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5613 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5614 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5616 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5617 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5620 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5622 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5626 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5627 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5628 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5629 redraw them. */
5631 static void
5632 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5634 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5635 Lisp_Object bar;
5637 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5638 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5639 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5640 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5641 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5642 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5643 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5644 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5645 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5646 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5650 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5652 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5653 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5654 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5655 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5657 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5658 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5660 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5662 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5663 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5665 static int temp_index;
5666 static short temp_buffer[100];
5668 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5669 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5670 temp_index = 0; \
5671 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5673 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5674 on a particular display. */
5676 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5678 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5679 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5680 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5681 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5683 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5685 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5686 do \
5688 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5689 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5690 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5691 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5692 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5693 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5695 while (0)
5697 enum
5699 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5700 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5701 X_EVENT_DROP
5704 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5705 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5706 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5708 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5709 this event further.
5710 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5712 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5713 static int
5714 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5716 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5717 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5718 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5719 was created. */
5721 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5722 event->xclient.window);
5724 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5726 #endif
5728 #ifdef USE_GTK
5729 static int current_count;
5730 static int current_finish;
5731 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5733 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5734 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5735 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5736 static GdkFilterReturn
5737 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5739 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5741 BLOCK_INPUT;
5742 if (current_count >= 0)
5744 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5746 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5748 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5749 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5750 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5751 so we do it here. */
5752 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5753 && dpyinfo
5754 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5756 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5757 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5759 #endif
5761 if (! dpyinfo)
5762 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5763 else
5764 current_count +=
5765 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5766 current_hold_quit);
5768 else
5769 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5771 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5773 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5774 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5776 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5778 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5781 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time,
5782 enum xembed_message message,
5783 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5785 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5787 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5788 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5789 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5791 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5793 static int
5794 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventp, int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5796 union {
5797 struct input_event ie;
5798 struct selection_input_event sie;
5799 } inev;
5800 int count = 0;
5801 int do_help = 0;
5802 int nbytes = 0;
5803 struct frame *f = NULL;
5804 struct coding_system coding;
5805 XEvent event = *eventp;
5806 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5808 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5810 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5811 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5812 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5814 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5815 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5817 switch (event.type)
5819 case ClientMessage:
5821 if (event.xclient.message_type
5822 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5823 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5825 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5826 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5828 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5829 could be the shell widget window
5830 if the frame has no title bar. */
5831 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5832 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5833 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5834 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5835 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5836 #endif
5837 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5838 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5839 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5840 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5841 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5842 needed.
5844 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5845 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5846 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5847 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5848 Emacs. */
5850 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5851 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5852 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5853 if (f)
5855 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5856 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5857 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5858 x_catch_errors (d);
5859 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5860 /* The ICCCM says this is
5861 the only valid choice. */
5862 RevertToParent,
5863 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5864 /* This is needed to detect the error
5865 if there is an error. */
5866 XSync (d, False);
5867 x_uncatch_errors ();
5869 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5870 #endif /* 0 */
5871 goto done;
5874 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5875 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5877 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5878 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5879 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5880 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5881 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5882 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5883 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5884 session manager and one for this. */
5885 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5886 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5887 #endif
5889 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5890 event.xclient.window);
5891 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5892 for a single Emacs process. */
5893 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5894 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5895 event.xclient.window,
5896 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5897 else if (f)
5898 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5899 event.xclient.window,
5900 0, 0);
5902 goto done;
5905 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5906 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5908 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5909 event.xclient.window);
5910 if (!f)
5911 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5913 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5914 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5915 goto done;
5918 goto done;
5921 if (event.xclient.message_type
5922 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5924 goto done;
5927 if (event.xclient.message_type
5928 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5930 int new_x, new_y;
5931 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5933 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5934 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5936 if (f)
5938 f->left_pos = new_x;
5939 f->top_pos = new_y;
5941 goto done;
5944 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5945 if (event.xclient.message_type
5946 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5948 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5949 if (f)
5950 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5951 &event, NULL);
5952 goto done;
5954 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5956 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5957 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5958 || (event.xclient.message_type
5959 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5961 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5962 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5963 currently never do because we are interested in
5964 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5965 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5966 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5967 if (!f)
5968 goto OTHER;
5969 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5970 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5971 goto done;
5974 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5975 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5976 we construct an input_event. */
5977 if (event.xclient.message_type
5978 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5980 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5981 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5982 goto done;
5984 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5986 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5987 if (event.xclient.message_type
5988 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5990 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5991 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5992 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5994 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5995 goto done;
5998 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6000 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6001 if (!f)
6002 goto OTHER;
6003 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6004 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6006 break;
6008 case SelectionNotify:
6009 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6010 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6011 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6012 goto OTHER;
6013 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6014 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6015 break;
6017 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6018 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6019 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6020 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6021 goto OTHER;
6022 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6024 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6026 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6027 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6028 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6029 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6030 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6032 break;
6034 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6035 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6036 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6037 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6038 goto OTHER;
6039 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6041 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6042 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6044 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6045 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6046 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6047 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6048 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6049 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6050 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6051 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6053 break;
6055 case PropertyNotify:
6056 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6057 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6058 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6059 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6061 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6062 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6063 goto OTHER;
6065 case ReparentNotify:
6066 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6067 if (f)
6069 int x, y;
6070 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6071 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6072 f->left_pos = x;
6073 f->top_pos = y;
6075 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6076 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6077 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6079 goto OTHER;
6081 case Expose:
6082 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6083 if (f)
6085 #ifdef USE_GTK
6086 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6087 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6088 event.xexpose.window,
6089 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6090 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6091 FALSE);
6092 #endif
6093 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6095 f->async_visible = 1;
6096 f->async_iconified = 0;
6097 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6098 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6100 else
6101 expose_frame (f,
6102 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6103 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6105 else
6107 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6108 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6109 #endif
6110 #if defined USE_LUCID
6111 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6112 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6113 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6115 Widget widget
6116 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6117 if (widget)
6118 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6120 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6122 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6123 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6124 goto OTHER;
6125 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6126 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6127 event.xexpose.window);
6129 if (bar)
6130 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6131 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6132 else
6133 goto OTHER;
6134 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6135 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6137 break;
6139 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6140 source area was obscured or not
6141 available. */
6142 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6143 if (f)
6145 expose_frame (f,
6146 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6147 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6148 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6150 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6151 else
6152 goto OTHER;
6153 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6154 break;
6156 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6157 source area was completely
6158 available. */
6159 break;
6161 case UnmapNotify:
6162 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6163 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6165 tip_window = 0;
6166 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6169 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6170 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6171 the frame was deleted. */
6173 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6174 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6175 display that won't ever be seen. */
6176 f->async_visible = 0;
6177 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6178 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6179 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6180 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6181 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6182 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6183 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6185 f->async_iconified = 1;
6187 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6188 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6191 goto OTHER;
6193 case MapNotify:
6194 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6195 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6196 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6197 goto OTHER;
6199 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6200 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6201 frame is visible. */
6202 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6203 if (f)
6205 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6206 the frame's display structures.
6207 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6208 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6209 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6210 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6211 if (! f->async_iconified)
6212 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6214 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6215 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6216 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6217 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6219 f->async_visible = 1;
6220 f->async_iconified = 0;
6221 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6223 if (f->iconified)
6225 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6226 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6228 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6229 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6230 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6231 to update the frame titles
6232 in case this is the second frame. */
6233 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6235 #ifdef USE_GTK
6236 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6237 #endif
6239 goto OTHER;
6241 case KeyPress:
6243 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6244 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6246 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6247 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6248 if (popup_activated ())
6249 goto OTHER;
6250 #endif
6252 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6254 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6255 mouse highlighting. */
6256 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6257 && (f == 0
6258 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6260 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6261 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6264 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6265 if (f == 0)
6267 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6268 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6269 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6270 event.xkey.window);
6271 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6273 widget = XtParent (widget);
6274 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6277 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6279 if (f != 0)
6281 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6282 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6283 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6284 his Emacs hang.
6286 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6287 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6288 status_return even if the input is too long to
6289 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6290 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6291 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6292 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6293 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6294 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6295 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6296 int modifiers;
6297 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6298 Lisp_Object c;
6300 #ifdef USE_GTK
6301 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6302 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6303 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6304 (see above). */
6305 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6306 #endif
6308 event.xkey.state
6309 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6310 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6311 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6313 /* This will have to go some day... */
6315 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6316 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6317 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6318 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6319 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6320 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6321 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6323 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6324 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6325 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6326 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6327 not it is combined with Meta. */
6328 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6329 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6331 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6332 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6334 Status status_return;
6336 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6337 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6338 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6339 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6340 &status_return);
6341 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6343 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6344 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6345 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6346 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6347 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6348 &status_return);
6350 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6351 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6352 break;
6353 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6355 keysym = NoSymbol;
6356 modifiers = 0;
6358 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6359 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6360 abort ();
6362 else
6363 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6364 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6365 &compose_status);
6366 #else
6367 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6368 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6369 &compose_status);
6370 #endif
6372 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6373 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6374 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6375 break;
6377 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6378 orig_keysym = keysym;
6380 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6381 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6382 inev.ie.modifiers
6383 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6384 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6386 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6387 translations to characters. */
6388 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6389 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6391 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6392 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6393 goto done_keysym;
6396 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6397 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6399 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6400 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6401 else
6402 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6403 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6404 goto done_keysym;
6407 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6408 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6409 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6410 Vx_keysym_table,
6411 Qnil))))
6413 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6414 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6415 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6416 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6417 goto done_keysym;
6420 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6421 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6422 || keysym == XK_Delete
6423 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6424 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6425 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6426 #endif
6427 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6428 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6429 #ifdef HPUX
6430 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6431 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6432 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6433 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6434 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6435 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6436 #endif
6437 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6438 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6439 #endif
6440 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6441 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6442 #endif
6443 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6444 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6445 #endif
6446 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6447 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6448 #endif
6449 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6450 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6451 #endif
6452 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6453 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6454 #endif
6455 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6456 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6457 #endif
6458 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6459 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6460 #endif
6461 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6462 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6463 #endif
6464 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6465 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6466 #endif
6467 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6468 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6469 #endif
6470 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6471 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6472 #endif
6473 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6474 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6475 #endif
6476 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6477 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6478 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6479 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6480 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6481 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6482 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6483 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6484 don't have real modifiers but
6485 should be treated similarly to
6486 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6487 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6488 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6489 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6490 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6491 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6492 #endif
6495 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6496 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6497 key. */
6498 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6499 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6500 goto done_keysym;
6503 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6504 register int i;
6505 register int c;
6506 int nchars, len;
6508 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6510 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6511 nchars++;
6512 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6515 if (nchars < nbytes)
6517 /* Decode the input data. */
6518 int require;
6520 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6521 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6522 we used just above and the locale. */
6523 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6524 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6525 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6526 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6527 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6528 gives us composition information. */
6529 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6531 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6532 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6533 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6534 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6535 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6536 nbytes = coding.produced;
6537 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6538 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6541 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6542 character events. */
6543 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6545 if (nchars == nbytes)
6546 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6547 else
6548 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6549 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6550 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6551 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6552 inev.ie.code = c;
6553 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6556 count += nchars;
6558 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6560 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6561 break;
6564 done_keysym:
6565 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6566 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6567 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6568 client. */
6569 break;
6570 #else
6571 goto OTHER;
6572 #endif
6574 case KeyRelease:
6575 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6576 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6577 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6578 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6579 client. */
6580 break;
6581 #else
6582 goto OTHER;
6583 #endif
6585 case EnterNotify:
6586 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6587 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6589 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6591 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6592 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6594 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6595 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6596 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6597 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6598 #ifdef USE_GTK
6599 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6600 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6601 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6602 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6603 #endif
6604 goto OTHER;
6606 case FocusIn:
6607 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6608 goto OTHER;
6610 case LeaveNotify:
6611 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6612 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6614 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6615 if (f)
6617 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6619 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6620 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6621 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6622 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6625 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6626 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6627 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6628 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6629 if (any_help_event_p)
6630 do_help = -1;
6632 #ifdef USE_GTK
6633 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6634 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6635 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6636 #endif
6637 goto OTHER;
6639 case FocusOut:
6640 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6641 goto OTHER;
6643 case MotionNotify:
6645 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6646 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6647 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6649 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6650 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6651 f = last_mouse_frame;
6652 else
6653 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6655 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6657 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6658 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6661 #ifdef USE_GTK
6662 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6663 f = 0;
6664 #endif
6665 if (f)
6668 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6669 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6670 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6672 Lisp_Object window;
6674 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6675 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6676 0, 0);
6678 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6679 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6680 will be selected only when it is active. */
6681 if (WINDOWP (window)
6682 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6683 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6684 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6685 create event iff we don't leave the
6686 selected frame. */
6687 && (focus_follows_mouse
6688 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6689 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6691 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6692 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6695 last_window=window;
6697 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6698 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6700 else
6702 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6703 struct scroll_bar *bar
6704 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6705 event.xmotion.window);
6707 if (bar)
6708 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6709 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6711 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6712 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6713 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6716 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6717 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6718 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6719 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6720 do_help = 1;
6721 goto OTHER;
6724 case ConfigureNotify:
6725 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6726 #ifdef USE_GTK
6727 if (!f
6728 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6729 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6731 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6732 event.xconfigure.height);
6733 f = 0;
6735 #endif
6736 if (f)
6738 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6739 #ifndef USE_GTK
6740 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6741 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6743 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6744 is called by the code that handles resizing
6745 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6747 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6748 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6749 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6750 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6751 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6752 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6753 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6755 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6756 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6757 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6760 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6761 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6762 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6763 #endif
6765 #ifdef USE_GTK
6766 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6767 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6768 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6769 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6770 #endif
6772 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6775 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6776 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6777 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6778 #endif
6781 goto OTHER;
6783 case ButtonRelease:
6784 case ButtonPress:
6786 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6787 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6788 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6790 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6791 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6792 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6794 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6795 && last_mouse_frame
6796 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6797 f = last_mouse_frame;
6798 else
6799 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6801 #ifdef USE_GTK
6802 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6803 f = 0;
6804 #endif
6805 if (f)
6807 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6808 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6809 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6811 Lisp_Object window;
6812 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6813 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6815 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6816 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6818 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6820 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6821 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6822 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6823 event.xbutton.state));
6827 if (!tool_bar_p)
6828 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6829 if (! popup_activated ())
6830 #endif
6832 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6834 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6835 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6837 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6838 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6840 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6841 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6843 else
6844 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6846 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6847 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6848 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6850 else
6852 struct scroll_bar *bar
6853 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6854 event.xbutton.window);
6856 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6857 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6858 scroll bars. */
6859 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6861 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6862 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6864 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6865 if (bar)
6866 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6867 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6870 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6872 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6873 last_mouse_frame = f;
6875 if (!tool_bar_p)
6876 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6878 else
6879 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6881 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6882 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6883 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6884 if (f != 0)
6885 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6887 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6888 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6889 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6890 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6891 Instead, save it away
6892 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6893 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6894 if (! popup_activated ()
6895 #ifdef USE_GTK
6896 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6897 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6898 #endif
6899 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6900 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6901 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6902 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6903 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6904 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6905 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6906 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6908 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6909 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6910 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6912 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6914 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6915 goto OTHER;
6917 else
6918 goto OTHER;
6919 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6921 break;
6923 case CirculateNotify:
6924 goto OTHER;
6926 case CirculateRequest:
6927 goto OTHER;
6929 case VisibilityNotify:
6930 goto OTHER;
6932 case MappingNotify:
6933 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6934 local cache. */
6935 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6937 case MappingModifier:
6938 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6939 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6940 case MappingKeyboard:
6941 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6943 goto OTHER;
6945 case DestroyNotify:
6946 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6947 break;
6949 default:
6950 OTHER:
6951 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6952 BLOCK_INPUT;
6953 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6954 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6955 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6956 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6957 break;
6960 done:
6961 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6963 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6964 count++;
6967 if (do_help
6968 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6970 Lisp_Object frame;
6972 if (f)
6973 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6974 else
6975 frame = Qnil;
6977 if (do_help > 0)
6979 any_help_event_p = 1;
6980 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6981 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6983 else
6985 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6986 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6988 count++;
6991 *eventp = event;
6992 return count;
6996 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6997 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6998 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7000 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7002 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7004 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7005 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7007 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7009 if (dpyinfo)
7010 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7012 return finish;
7016 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7017 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7018 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7020 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7021 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7022 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7023 C chars).
7025 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7027 static int
7028 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7030 int count = 0;
7031 XEvent event;
7032 int event_found = 0;
7034 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7036 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7037 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7038 pending_signals = 1;
7039 #endif
7040 return -1;
7043 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7044 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7045 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7046 #endif
7047 BLOCK_INPUT;
7049 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7050 input_signal_count++;
7052 ++handling_signal;
7054 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7055 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7057 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7058 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7061 #ifndef USE_GTK
7062 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7064 int finish;
7066 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7068 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7069 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7070 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7071 continue;
7072 #endif
7073 event_found = 1;
7075 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7076 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7078 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7079 goto out;
7082 #else /* USE_GTK */
7084 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7085 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7086 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7087 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7089 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7090 from all displays. */
7092 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7094 current_count = count;
7095 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7097 gtk_main_iteration ();
7099 count = current_count;
7100 current_count = -1;
7101 current_hold_quit = 0;
7103 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7104 break;
7106 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7108 out:;
7110 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7111 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7112 if (! event_found)
7114 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7115 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7116 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7117 x_noop_count++;
7118 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7120 x_noop_count=0;
7122 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7123 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7125 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7127 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7128 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7132 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7133 raise it now. */
7134 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7135 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7137 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7138 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7141 --handling_signal;
7142 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7144 return count;
7150 /***********************************************************************
7151 Text Cursor
7152 ***********************************************************************/
7154 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7155 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7157 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7158 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7159 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7161 static void
7162 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7164 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7165 XRectangle clip_rect;
7166 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7168 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7170 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7171 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7172 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7173 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7174 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7176 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7180 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7182 static void
7183 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7185 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7186 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7187 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7188 int x, y, wd, h;
7189 XGCValues xgcv;
7190 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7191 GC gc;
7193 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7194 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7195 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7196 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7197 return;
7199 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7200 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7201 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7203 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7204 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7205 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7206 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7207 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7208 else
7209 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7210 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7211 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7213 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7214 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7215 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7216 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7220 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7222 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7223 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7224 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7225 --gerd. */
7227 static void
7228 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7230 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7231 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7233 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7234 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7235 and mini-buffer. */
7236 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7237 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7238 return;
7240 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7241 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7242 the bar might not be in the window. */
7243 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7245 struct glyph_row *row;
7246 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7247 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7249 else
7251 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7252 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7253 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7254 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7255 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7256 XGCValues xgcv;
7258 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7259 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7260 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7261 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7262 that the glyph is legible. */
7263 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7264 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7265 else
7266 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7267 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7269 if (gc)
7270 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7271 else
7273 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7274 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7277 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7279 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7281 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7283 if (width < 0)
7284 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7285 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7287 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7289 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7290 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7291 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7292 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7294 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7295 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7296 width, row->height);
7298 else
7300 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7302 if (width < 0)
7303 width = row->height;
7305 width = min (row->height, width);
7307 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7308 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7310 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7311 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7312 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7313 row->height - width),
7314 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7317 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7322 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7324 static void
7325 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7327 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7328 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7329 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7330 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7334 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7336 static void
7337 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7339 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7340 x, y, width, height, False);
7341 #ifdef USE_GTK
7342 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7343 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7344 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7345 #endif
7349 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7351 static void
7352 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7354 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7356 if (on_p)
7358 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7359 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7361 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7362 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7363 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7364 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7366 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7367 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7369 else
7371 switch (cursor_type)
7373 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7374 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7375 break;
7377 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7378 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7379 break;
7381 case BAR_CURSOR:
7382 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7383 break;
7385 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7386 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7387 break;
7389 case NO_CURSOR:
7390 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7391 break;
7393 default:
7394 abort ();
7398 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7399 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7400 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7401 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7402 #endif
7405 #ifndef XFlush
7406 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7407 #endif
7411 /* Icons. */
7413 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7416 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7418 int bitmap_id;
7420 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7421 return 1;
7423 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7424 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7425 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7426 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7428 if (STRINGP (file))
7430 #ifdef USE_GTK
7431 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7432 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7433 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7434 return 0;
7435 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7436 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7437 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7439 else
7441 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7442 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7444 int rc = -1;
7446 #ifdef USE_GTK
7448 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7449 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7450 return 0;
7452 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7454 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7455 if (rc != -1)
7456 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7458 #endif
7460 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7461 if (rc == -1)
7463 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7464 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7465 if (rc == -1)
7466 return 1;
7468 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7469 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7473 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7474 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7475 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7476 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7477 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7479 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7482 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7483 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7485 return 0;
7489 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7490 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7493 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7495 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7496 return 1;
7499 XTextProperty text;
7500 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7501 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7502 text.format = 8;
7503 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7504 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7507 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7508 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7509 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7510 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7512 return 0;
7515 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7517 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7518 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7520 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7521 be called from a signal handler.
7524 struct x_error_message_stack {
7525 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7526 Display *dpy;
7527 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7529 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7531 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7532 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7533 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7535 static void
7536 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7538 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7539 x_error_message->string,
7540 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7543 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7544 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7545 operating on.
7547 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7548 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7549 stored in *x_error_message.
7551 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7552 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7554 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7556 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7558 void
7559 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7561 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7563 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7564 XSync (dpy, False);
7566 data->dpy = dpy;
7567 data->string[0] = 0;
7568 data->prev = x_error_message;
7569 x_error_message = data;
7572 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7573 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7575 void
7576 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7578 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7580 BLOCK_INPUT;
7582 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7583 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7584 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7585 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7587 tmp = x_error_message;
7588 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7589 xfree (tmp);
7590 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7593 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7594 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7595 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7597 void
7598 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7600 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7601 XSync (dpy, False);
7603 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7605 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7606 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7607 x_uncatch_errors ();
7608 error (format, string);
7612 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7613 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7616 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7618 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7619 XSync (dpy, False);
7621 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7624 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7626 void
7627 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7629 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7632 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7633 * idea. --lorentey */
7634 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7636 void
7637 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7639 while (x_error_message)
7640 x_uncatch_errors ();
7642 #endif
7644 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7647 x_catching_errors (void)
7649 return x_error_message != 0;
7652 #if 0
7653 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7654 x_trace_wire (void)
7656 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7658 #endif /* ! 0 */
7661 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7662 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7663 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7664 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7665 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7667 static SIGTYPE
7668 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7669 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7671 #ifdef USG
7672 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7673 must reestablish each time */
7674 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7675 #endif /* USG */
7679 /************************************************************************
7680 Handling X errors
7681 ************************************************************************/
7683 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7685 static char *error_msg;
7687 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7688 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7689 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7691 static void
7692 x_fatal_error_signal (void)
7694 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7695 exit (70);
7698 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7699 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7701 static SIGTYPE
7702 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7704 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7705 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7706 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7708 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7709 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7710 handling_signal = 0;
7712 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7713 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7715 if (dpyinfo)
7717 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7718 frame on it. */
7719 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7720 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7723 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7724 that are on the dead display. */
7725 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7727 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7728 minibuf_frame
7729 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7730 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7731 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7732 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7733 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7734 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7737 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7738 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7739 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7740 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7741 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7742 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7744 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7745 trying to find a replacement. */
7746 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7747 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7750 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7751 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7752 if (dpyinfo)
7754 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7755 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7756 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7757 #ifdef USE_GTK
7758 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7759 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7760 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7761 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7762 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7763 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7764 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7765 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7766 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7767 error_msg);
7768 abort ();
7769 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7771 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7772 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7774 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7775 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7776 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7777 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7778 abort ();
7781 Lisp_Object tmp;
7782 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7783 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7787 if (terminal_list == 0)
7789 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7790 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7791 /* NOTREACHED */
7794 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7795 #ifdef SIGIO
7796 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7797 #endif
7798 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7799 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7801 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7802 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7803 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7804 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7805 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7806 error ("%s", error_msg);
7809 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7810 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7811 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7813 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7814 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7816 static int
7817 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7819 if (x_error_message)
7820 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7821 else
7822 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7823 return 0;
7826 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7827 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7828 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7830 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7832 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7833 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7835 static void NO_INLINE
7836 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7838 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7840 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7841 or colors that are not defined. */
7843 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7844 return;
7846 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7847 original error handler. */
7849 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7850 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7851 buf, error->request_code);
7852 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7856 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7857 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7858 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7860 static int
7861 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7863 char buf[256];
7865 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7866 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7867 return 0;
7870 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7872 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7873 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7874 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7875 FONT-OBJECT. */
7877 Lisp_Object
7878 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7880 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7882 if (fontset < 0)
7883 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7884 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7885 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7886 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7887 do. */
7888 return font_object;
7890 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7891 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7892 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7893 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7894 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7896 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7898 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7899 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7901 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7902 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7903 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7905 else
7907 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7908 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7911 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7913 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7914 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7915 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7916 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7917 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7920 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7921 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7922 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7924 BLOCK_INPUT;
7925 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7926 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7928 #endif
7930 return font_object;
7934 /***********************************************************************
7935 X Input Methods
7936 ***********************************************************************/
7938 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7940 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7942 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7943 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7944 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7946 static void
7947 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7949 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7950 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7952 BLOCK_INPUT;
7954 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7955 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7957 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7958 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7960 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7961 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7965 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7966 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7967 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7968 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7971 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7973 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7974 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7975 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7976 #endif
7978 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7979 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7981 static void
7982 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7984 XIM xim;
7986 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7987 if (use_xim)
7989 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7990 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7991 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7992 emacs_class);
7993 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7995 if (xim)
7997 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7998 XIMCallback destroy;
7999 #endif
8001 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8002 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8004 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8005 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8006 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8007 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8008 #endif
8012 else
8013 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8014 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8018 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8020 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8021 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8022 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8023 when the callback was registered. */
8025 static void
8026 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8028 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8029 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8031 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8032 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8033 return;
8035 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8037 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8038 as they have no XIC. */
8039 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8041 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8043 BLOCK_INPUT;
8044 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8046 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8048 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8049 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8050 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8052 create_frame_xic (f);
8053 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8054 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8055 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8057 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8058 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8063 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8067 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8070 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8071 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8072 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8073 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8075 static void
8076 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8078 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8079 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8080 if (use_xim)
8082 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8083 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8084 int len;
8086 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8087 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8088 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8089 len = strlen (resource_name);
8090 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8091 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8092 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8093 resource_name, emacs_class,
8094 xim_instantiate_callback,
8095 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8096 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8097 least, hence the configure test. */
8098 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8099 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8100 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8101 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8103 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8107 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8109 static void
8110 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8112 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8113 if (use_xim)
8115 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8116 if (dpyinfo->display)
8117 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8118 NULL, emacs_class,
8119 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8120 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8121 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8122 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8123 if (dpyinfo->display)
8124 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8125 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8126 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8128 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8131 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8135 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8136 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8138 void
8139 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8141 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8143 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8144 is already for the top-left corner. */
8145 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8146 return;
8148 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8149 position that fits on the screen. */
8150 if (flags & XNegative)
8151 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8152 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8155 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8157 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8158 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8159 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8161 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8162 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8163 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8164 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8165 is right, though.
8167 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8168 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8170 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8171 #endif
8173 if (flags & YNegative)
8174 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8175 - height + f->top_pos;
8178 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8179 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8180 so the flags should correspond. */
8181 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8184 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8185 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8186 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8187 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8188 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8190 void
8191 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8193 int modified_top, modified_left;
8195 if (change_gravity > 0)
8197 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8198 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8200 f->top_pos = yoff;
8201 f->left_pos = xoff;
8202 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8203 if (xoff < 0)
8204 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8205 if (yoff < 0)
8206 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8207 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8209 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8211 BLOCK_INPUT;
8212 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8214 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8215 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8217 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8219 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8220 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8221 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8222 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8223 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8226 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8227 modified_left, modified_top);
8229 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8230 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8231 ? 1 : 0);
8233 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8234 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8235 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8236 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8237 of the frame.
8239 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8240 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8241 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8243 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8244 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8245 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8246 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8247 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8248 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8250 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8253 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8254 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8255 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8256 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8257 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8259 static int
8260 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8262 Atom actual_type;
8263 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8264 int i, rc, actual_format;
8265 Window wmcheck_window;
8266 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8267 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8268 long max_len = 65536;
8269 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8270 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8271 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8273 BLOCK_INPUT;
8275 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8276 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8277 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8278 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8279 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8280 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8282 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8284 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8285 x_uncatch_errors ();
8286 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8287 return 0;
8290 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8291 XFree (tmp_data);
8293 /* Check if window exists. */
8294 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8295 x_sync (f);
8296 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8298 x_uncatch_errors ();
8299 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8300 return 0;
8303 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8305 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8306 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8307 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8308 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8309 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8310 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8312 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8313 tmp_data = NULL;
8314 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8315 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8316 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8317 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8318 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8320 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8322 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8323 x_uncatch_errors ();
8324 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8325 return 0;
8328 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8329 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8330 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8333 rc = 0;
8335 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8336 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8338 x_uncatch_errors ();
8339 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8341 return rc;
8344 static void
8345 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8349 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8350 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8351 make_number (32),
8352 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8353 Fcons
8354 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8355 Fcons
8356 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8357 value != 0
8358 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8359 : Qnil)));
8362 void
8363 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8365 Lisp_Object frame;
8366 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8368 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8370 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8371 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8374 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8375 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8376 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8378 static void
8379 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8380 Window window,
8381 int *size_state,
8382 int *sticky)
8384 Atom actual_type;
8385 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8386 int i, rc, actual_format;
8387 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8388 long max_len = 65536;
8389 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8390 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8391 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8393 *sticky = 0;
8394 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8396 BLOCK_INPUT;
8397 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8398 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8399 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8400 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8401 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8403 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8405 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8406 x_uncatch_errors ();
8407 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8408 return;
8411 x_uncatch_errors ();
8413 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8415 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8416 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8418 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8419 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8420 else
8421 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8423 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8425 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8426 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8427 else
8428 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8430 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8431 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8432 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8433 *sticky = 1;
8436 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8437 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8440 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8442 static int
8443 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8445 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8446 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8447 int cur, dummy;
8449 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8451 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8452 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8453 if (!have_net_atom)
8454 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8456 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8458 Lisp_Object frame;
8460 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8462 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8463 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8464 are sent at once. */
8465 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8467 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8468 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8469 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8470 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8471 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8472 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8473 break;
8474 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8475 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8476 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8477 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8478 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8479 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8480 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8481 break;
8482 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8483 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8484 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8485 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8486 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8487 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8488 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8489 break;
8490 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8491 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8492 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8493 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8494 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8495 break;
8496 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8497 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8498 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8499 else
8500 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8501 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8504 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8508 return have_net_atom;
8511 static void
8512 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8514 if (f->async_visible)
8516 BLOCK_INPUT;
8517 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8518 x_sync (f);
8519 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8524 static void
8525 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8527 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8528 Lisp_Object lval;
8529 int sticky = 0;
8531 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8532 lval = Qnil;
8533 switch (value)
8535 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8536 lval = Qfullwidth;
8537 break;
8538 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8539 lval = Qfullheight;
8540 break;
8541 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8542 lval = Qfullboth;
8543 break;
8544 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8545 lval = Qmaximized;
8546 break;
8549 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8550 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8553 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8554 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8555 static void
8556 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8558 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8559 return;
8561 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8562 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8564 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8565 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8566 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8568 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8570 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8571 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8573 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8575 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8576 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8577 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8578 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8579 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8580 break;
8581 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8582 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8583 break;
8584 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8585 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8588 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8589 width, height);
8593 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8594 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8595 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8596 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8597 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8598 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8599 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8601 static void
8602 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8604 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8606 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8607 window manager window around the frame. */
8609 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8611 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8613 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8615 int adjusted_left;
8616 int adjusted_top;
8618 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8619 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8620 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8622 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8624 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8625 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8627 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8628 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8630 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8632 else
8633 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8634 frame's position. */
8636 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8640 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8641 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8642 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8643 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8644 of an exact comparison. */
8646 static void
8647 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8649 int count = 0;
8651 while (count++ < 50)
8653 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8655 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8656 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8657 loop. */
8659 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8660 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8662 if (fuzzy)
8664 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8665 pixels. */
8667 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8668 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8669 return;
8671 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8672 return;
8675 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8676 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8678 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8682 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8683 void
8684 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8686 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8688 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8689 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8690 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8692 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8693 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8695 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8696 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8697 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8698 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8699 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8701 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8703 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8704 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8705 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8706 BLOCK_INPUT;
8707 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8709 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8710 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8712 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8713 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8715 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8716 break; /* Timeout */
8718 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8719 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8723 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8724 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8725 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8726 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8728 static void
8729 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8731 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8733 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8734 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8735 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8737 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8739 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8741 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8742 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8743 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8744 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8746 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8747 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8748 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8749 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8752 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8753 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8754 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8755 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8756 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8758 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8759 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8760 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8761 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8763 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8764 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8765 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8766 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8767 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8769 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8770 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8772 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8773 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8774 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8775 if (f->async_visible)
8776 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8777 else
8779 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8780 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8781 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8782 x_sync (f);
8787 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8788 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8789 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8790 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8792 void
8793 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8795 BLOCK_INPUT;
8797 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8799 int r, c;
8801 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8802 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8803 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8804 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8805 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8806 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8807 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8808 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8809 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8810 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8811 is however. */
8812 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8813 #endif
8814 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8815 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8816 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8817 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8818 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8819 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8820 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8823 #ifdef USE_GTK
8824 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8825 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8826 else
8827 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8828 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8830 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8832 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8834 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8835 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8837 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8838 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8839 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8840 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8841 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8843 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8846 /* Mouse warping. */
8848 void
8849 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8851 int pix_x, pix_y;
8853 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8854 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8856 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8857 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8859 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8860 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8862 BLOCK_INPUT;
8864 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8865 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8866 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8869 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8871 void
8872 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8874 BLOCK_INPUT;
8876 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8877 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8878 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8881 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8883 void
8884 x_focus_on_frame (struct frame *f)
8886 #if 0
8887 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8888 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8889 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8890 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8891 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8892 #endif /* ! 0 */
8895 void
8896 x_unfocus_frame (struct frame *f)
8898 #if 0
8899 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8900 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8901 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8902 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8903 #endif /* ! 0 */
8906 /* Raise frame F. */
8908 void
8909 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8911 BLOCK_INPUT;
8912 if (f->async_visible)
8913 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8915 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8916 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8919 /* Lower frame F. */
8921 void
8922 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8924 if (f->async_visible)
8926 BLOCK_INPUT;
8927 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8928 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8929 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8933 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8935 void
8936 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8938 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8939 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8941 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8942 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8944 Lisp_Object frame;
8945 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8946 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8947 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8948 make_number (32),
8949 Fcons (make_number (1),
8950 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8951 Qnil)));
8955 static void
8956 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8958 if (raise_flag)
8959 x_raise_frame (f);
8960 else
8961 x_lower_frame (f);
8964 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8966 static void
8967 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8969 unsigned long data[2];
8970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8972 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8973 data[1] = flags;
8975 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8976 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8977 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8980 static void
8981 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time, enum xembed_message message, long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8983 XEvent event;
8985 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8986 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8987 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
8988 event.xclient.format = 32;
8989 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
8990 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
8991 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
8992 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
8993 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
8995 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
8996 False, NoEventMask, &event);
8997 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9000 /* Change of visibility. */
9002 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9003 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9004 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9005 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9006 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9007 finishes with it. */
9009 void
9010 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9012 Lisp_Object type;
9013 int original_top, original_left;
9014 int retry_count = 2;
9016 retry:
9018 BLOCK_INPUT;
9020 type = x_icon_type (f);
9021 if (!NILP (type))
9022 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9024 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9026 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9027 call x_set_offset a second time
9028 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9029 before the window gets really visible. */
9030 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9031 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9032 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9033 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9035 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9037 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9038 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9039 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9040 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9041 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9042 else
9044 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9045 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9047 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9048 #ifdef USE_GTK
9049 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9050 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9051 #else
9052 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9053 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9054 else
9055 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9056 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9057 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9060 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9062 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9063 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9064 so that incoming events are handled. */
9066 Lisp_Object frame;
9067 int count;
9068 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9069 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9070 will set it when they are handled. */
9071 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9073 original_left = f->left_pos;
9074 original_top = f->top_pos;
9076 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9077 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9079 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9081 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9082 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9083 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9084 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9086 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9087 because the window manager may choose the position
9088 and we don't want to override it. */
9090 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9091 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9092 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9093 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9094 && previously_visible)
9096 Drawable rootw;
9097 int x, y;
9098 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9100 BLOCK_INPUT;
9102 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9103 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9104 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9105 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9106 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9107 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9108 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9109 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9110 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9112 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9113 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9114 original_left, original_top);
9116 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9119 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9121 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9122 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9123 MapNotify at all.. */
9124 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9125 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9127 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9128 x_sync (f);
9130 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9131 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9132 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9133 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9134 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9135 probably a bug. */
9136 if (input_polling_used ())
9138 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9139 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9140 handler reset it. */
9141 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9142 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9143 poll_for_input_1 ();
9144 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9147 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9148 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9151 /* 2000-09-28: In
9153 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9154 (iconify-frame f)
9155 (raise-frame f))
9157 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9158 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9159 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9160 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9162 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9163 goto retry;
9167 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9169 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9171 void
9172 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9174 Window window;
9176 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9177 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9179 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9180 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9181 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9183 BLOCK_INPUT;
9185 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9186 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9187 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9188 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9189 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9190 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9192 #ifdef USE_GTK
9193 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9194 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9195 else
9196 #else
9197 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9198 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9199 else
9200 #endif
9203 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9204 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9206 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9207 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9211 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9212 just by the event that we get from the server.
9213 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9214 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9215 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9216 f->visible = 0;
9217 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9218 f->async_visible = 0;
9219 f->async_iconified = 0;
9221 x_sync (f);
9223 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9226 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9228 void
9229 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9231 int result;
9232 Lisp_Object type;
9234 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9235 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9236 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9238 if (f->async_iconified)
9239 return;
9241 BLOCK_INPUT;
9243 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9245 type = x_icon_type (f);
9246 if (!NILP (type))
9247 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9249 #ifdef USE_GTK
9250 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9252 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9253 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9255 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9256 f->iconified = 1;
9257 f->visible = 1;
9258 f->async_iconified = 1;
9259 f->async_visible = 0;
9260 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9261 return;
9263 #endif
9265 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9267 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9269 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9270 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9271 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9272 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9273 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9274 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9275 so we have to record it here. */
9276 f->iconified = 1;
9277 f->visible = 1;
9278 f->async_iconified = 1;
9279 f->async_visible = 0;
9280 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9281 return;
9284 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9285 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9286 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9287 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9289 if (!result)
9290 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9292 f->async_iconified = 1;
9293 f->async_visible = 0;
9296 BLOCK_INPUT;
9297 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9298 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9299 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9301 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9302 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9303 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9304 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9305 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9306 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9308 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9309 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9311 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9312 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9314 XEvent message;
9316 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9317 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9318 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9319 message.xclient.format = 32;
9320 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9322 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9323 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9324 False,
9325 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9326 &message))
9328 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9329 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9333 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9334 IconicState. */
9335 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9337 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9339 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9340 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9343 f->async_iconified = 1;
9344 f->async_visible = 0;
9346 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9347 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9348 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9352 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9354 void
9355 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9357 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9358 Lisp_Object bar;
9359 struct scroll_bar *b;
9360 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9362 BLOCK_INPUT;
9364 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9365 commands to the X server. */
9366 if (dpyinfo->display)
9368 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9369 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9370 face. */
9371 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9372 free_frame_faces (f);
9374 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9375 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9377 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9378 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9379 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9380 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9381 toolkit scroll bars. */
9382 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9384 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9385 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9387 #endif
9389 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9390 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9391 free_frame_xic (f);
9392 #endif
9394 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9395 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9397 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9398 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9400 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9401 we are using a toolkit. */
9402 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9403 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9405 free_frame_menubar (f);
9406 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9408 #ifdef USE_GTK
9409 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9410 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9412 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9413 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9414 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9416 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9417 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9418 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9419 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9420 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9421 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9423 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9424 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9425 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9426 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9427 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9428 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9429 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9430 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9431 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9432 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9433 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9434 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9435 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9436 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9437 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9439 x_free_gcs (f);
9440 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9443 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9444 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9445 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9447 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9448 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9449 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9450 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9451 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9452 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9454 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9456 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9457 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9458 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9459 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9460 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9461 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9462 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9465 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9469 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9471 void
9472 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9474 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9476 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9477 commands to the X server. */
9478 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9479 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9481 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9485 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9487 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9488 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9489 that the window now has.
9490 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9491 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9492 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9494 #ifndef USE_GTK
9495 void
9496 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9498 XSizeHints size_hints;
9499 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9501 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9502 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9504 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9505 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9507 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9508 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9510 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9511 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9512 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9513 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9514 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9515 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9517 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9519 int base_width, base_height;
9520 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9522 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9523 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9525 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9527 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9528 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9529 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9530 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9531 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9533 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9534 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9535 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9537 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9538 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9539 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9540 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9541 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9544 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9545 if (flags)
9547 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9548 goto no_read;
9552 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9553 long supplied_return;
9554 int value;
9556 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9557 &supplied_return);
9559 if (flags)
9560 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9561 else
9563 if (value == 0)
9564 hints.flags = 0;
9565 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9566 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9567 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9568 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9569 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9570 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9571 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9572 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9576 no_read:
9578 #ifdef PWinGravity
9579 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9580 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9582 if (user_position)
9584 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9585 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9587 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9589 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9591 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9593 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9595 void
9596 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9598 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9599 Arg al[1];
9601 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9602 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9603 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9604 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9606 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9607 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9609 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9610 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9613 void
9614 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9616 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9618 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9619 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9620 #endif
9622 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9624 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9625 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9626 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9627 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9629 else
9631 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9632 pixmap. */
9633 return;
9637 #ifdef USE_GTK
9639 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9640 return;
9643 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9646 Arg al[1];
9647 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9648 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9649 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9650 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9653 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9655 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9656 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9658 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9661 void
9662 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9664 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9666 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9667 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9668 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9670 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9674 /***********************************************************************
9675 Fonts
9676 ***********************************************************************/
9678 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9680 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9681 font table. */
9683 static void
9684 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9686 Lisp_Object frame;
9688 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9689 if (font->driver->check)
9690 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9693 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9696 /***********************************************************************
9697 Initialization
9698 ***********************************************************************/
9700 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9701 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9702 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9703 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9705 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9706 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9707 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9709 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9710 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9711 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9712 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9713 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9714 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9715 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9718 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9720 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9722 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9724 static int x_initialized;
9726 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9727 the screen number from the server number. */
9728 static int
9729 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9731 int seen_colon = 0;
9732 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9733 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9734 int length_until_period = 0;
9736 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9737 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9738 length_until_period++;
9740 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9741 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9742 name1 += 4;
9743 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9744 name2 += 4;
9745 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9746 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9747 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9748 name1 += system_name_length;
9749 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9750 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9751 name2 += system_name_length;
9752 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9753 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9754 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9755 name1 += length_until_period;
9756 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9757 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9758 name2 += length_until_period;
9760 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9762 if (*name1 == ':')
9763 seen_colon++;
9764 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9765 return 1;
9767 return (seen_colon
9768 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9769 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9772 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9773 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9774 to 5. */
9775 static void
9776 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9778 int nr = 0;
9779 int off = 0;
9781 while (!(mask & 1))
9783 off++;
9784 mask >>= 1;
9787 while (mask & 1)
9789 nr++;
9790 mask >>= 1;
9793 *offset = off;
9794 *bits = nr;
9797 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9798 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9801 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9803 int dpy_ok = 1;
9804 Display *dpy;
9806 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9807 if (dpy)
9808 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9809 else
9810 dpy_ok = 0;
9811 return dpy_ok;
9814 #ifdef USE_GTK
9815 static void
9816 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level, const gchar *message, gpointer user_data)
9818 if (!strstr (message, "g_set_prgname"))
9819 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, message);
9821 #endif
9823 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9824 the structure that describes the open display.
9825 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9827 struct x_display_info *
9828 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9830 int connection;
9831 Display *dpy;
9832 struct terminal *terminal;
9833 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9834 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9835 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9837 BLOCK_INPUT;
9839 if (!x_initialized)
9841 x_initialize ();
9842 ++x_initialized;
9845 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9846 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9848 #ifdef USE_GTK
9850 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9851 int argc;
9852 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9853 char **argv2 = argv;
9854 guint id;
9856 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9858 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9860 else
9862 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9863 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9865 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9866 argv[argc] = 0;
9868 argc = 0;
9869 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9871 if (! NILP (display_name))
9873 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9874 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9877 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9878 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9880 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9882 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9883 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9885 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9886 putenv (fix_events);
9889 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9890 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9891 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9892 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9893 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9894 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9896 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9897 fixup_locale ();
9898 xg_initialize ();
9900 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9902 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9903 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9905 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9906 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9908 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9909 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9911 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9912 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9914 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9915 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9917 #endif
9919 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9920 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9923 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9924 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9925 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9926 errors with X11R5:
9927 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9928 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9929 So let's not use it until R6. */
9930 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9931 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9932 #endif
9935 int argc = 0;
9936 char *argv[3];
9938 argv[0] = "";
9939 argc = 1;
9940 if (xrm_option)
9942 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9943 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9945 turn_on_atimers (0);
9946 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9947 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9948 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9949 &argc, argv);
9950 turn_on_atimers (1);
9952 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9953 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9954 fixup_locale ();
9955 #endif
9958 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9959 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9960 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9961 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9962 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9964 /* Detect failure. */
9965 if (dpy == 0)
9967 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9968 return 0;
9971 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9973 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9974 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9975 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9977 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9980 struct x_display_info *share;
9981 Lisp_Object tail;
9983 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9984 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
9985 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
9986 SSDATA (display_name)))
9987 break;
9988 if (share)
9989 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
9990 else
9992 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
9993 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
9994 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
9996 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9997 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9998 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9999 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10000 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10002 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10004 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10006 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10007 list of terminals. */
10008 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10009 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10010 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10011 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10013 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10014 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10015 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10016 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10017 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10018 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10019 BLOCK_INPUT;
10020 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10021 terminal_list = terminal;
10022 UNGCPRO;
10025 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10026 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10027 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10028 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10029 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10031 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10034 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10035 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10036 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10038 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10039 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10040 x_display_name_list);
10041 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10043 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10045 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10046 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10047 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10048 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10050 #if 0
10051 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10052 #endif /* ! 0 */
10054 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10055 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10056 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10057 + 2);
10058 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10059 SSDATA (Vinvocation_name), SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10061 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10062 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10064 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10065 #ifdef USE_GTK
10066 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10067 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10068 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10070 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10071 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10073 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10074 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10075 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10076 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10077 #else
10078 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10079 #endif
10080 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10081 all versions. */
10082 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10084 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10085 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10086 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10087 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10088 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10089 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10090 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10091 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10092 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10093 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10094 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10095 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10096 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10097 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10098 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10099 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10100 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10101 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10102 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10103 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10104 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10105 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10106 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10107 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10108 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10109 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10110 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10111 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10113 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10114 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10115 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10117 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10119 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10120 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10121 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10122 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10123 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10124 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10127 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10128 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10130 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10132 Lisp_Object value;
10133 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10134 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10135 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10136 Qnil, Qnil);
10137 if (STRINGP (value)
10138 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10139 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10140 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10143 else
10144 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10145 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10147 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10149 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10150 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10151 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10152 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10153 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10154 for example). */
10155 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10156 double d;
10157 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10158 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10160 #endif
10162 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10164 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10165 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10166 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10167 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10168 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10169 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10170 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10171 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10172 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10176 const struct
10178 const char *name;
10179 Atom *atom;
10180 } atom_refs[] = {
10181 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10182 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10183 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10184 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10185 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10186 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10187 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10188 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10189 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10190 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10191 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10192 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10193 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10194 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10195 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10196 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10197 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10198 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10199 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10200 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10201 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10202 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10203 /* For properties of font. */
10204 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10205 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10206 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10207 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10208 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10209 /* Ghostscript support. */
10210 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10211 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10212 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10213 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10214 /* EWMH */
10215 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10216 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10217 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10218 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10219 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10220 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10221 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10222 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10223 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10224 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10225 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10226 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10227 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10228 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10229 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10230 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10231 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10232 /* Session management */
10233 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10234 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10235 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10238 int i;
10239 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10240 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10241 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10242 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10243 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10244 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10246 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10247 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10249 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10250 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10251 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10252 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10254 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10255 False, atoms_return);
10257 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10258 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10260 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10261 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10263 xfree (atom_names);
10264 xfree (atoms_return);
10267 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10268 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10269 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10270 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10272 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10273 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10274 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10276 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10277 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10280 dpyinfo->gray
10281 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10282 gray_bitmap_bits,
10283 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10284 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10287 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10288 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10289 #endif
10291 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10293 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10294 if (connection != 0)
10295 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10297 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10298 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10299 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10301 #ifdef SIGIO
10302 if (interrupt_input)
10303 init_sigio (connection);
10304 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10306 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10308 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10309 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10310 Font font;
10312 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10313 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10314 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10315 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10316 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10317 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10318 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10319 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10320 abort ();
10321 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10322 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10323 x_uncatch_errors ();
10325 #endif
10327 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10328 for debugging X code. */
10330 Lisp_Object value;
10331 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10332 build_string ("synchronous"),
10333 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10334 Qnil, Qnil);
10335 if (STRINGP (value)
10336 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10337 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10338 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10342 Lisp_Object value;
10343 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10344 build_string ("useXIM"),
10345 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10346 Qnil, Qnil);
10347 #ifdef USE_XIM
10348 if (STRINGP (value)
10349 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10350 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10351 use_xim = 0;
10352 #else
10353 if (STRINGP (value)
10354 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10355 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10356 use_xim = 1;
10357 #endif
10360 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10361 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10362 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10363 tty. */
10364 if (terminal->id == 1)
10365 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10366 #endif
10368 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10370 return dpyinfo;
10373 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10374 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10376 void
10377 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10379 struct terminal *t;
10381 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10382 X display. */
10383 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10384 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10386 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10387 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10388 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10389 x_session_close ();
10390 #endif
10391 delete_terminal (t);
10392 break;
10395 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10397 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10398 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10399 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10400 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10401 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10402 else
10404 Lisp_Object tail;
10406 tail = x_display_name_list;
10407 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10409 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10411 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10412 break;
10414 tail = XCDR (tail);
10418 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10419 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10421 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10422 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10423 else
10425 struct x_display_info *tail;
10427 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10428 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10429 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10432 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10433 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10434 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10435 xfree (dpyinfo);
10438 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10440 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10441 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10442 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10443 that slows us down. */
10445 static void
10446 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10448 BLOCK_INPUT;
10449 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10450 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10452 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10453 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10454 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10455 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10457 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10460 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10461 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10462 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10463 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10464 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10465 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10466 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10468 void
10469 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10471 BLOCK_INPUT;
10472 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10474 EMACS_TIME interval;
10476 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10477 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10478 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10480 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10483 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10486 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10488 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10490 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10492 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10493 x_produce_glyphs,
10494 x_write_glyphs,
10495 x_insert_glyphs,
10496 x_clear_end_of_line,
10497 x_scroll_run,
10498 x_after_update_window_line,
10499 x_update_window_begin,
10500 x_update_window_end,
10501 x_cursor_to,
10502 x_flush,
10503 #ifdef XFlush
10504 x_flush,
10505 #else
10506 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10507 #endif
10508 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10509 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10510 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10511 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10512 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10513 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10514 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10515 x_draw_glyph_string,
10516 x_define_frame_cursor,
10517 x_clear_frame_area,
10518 x_draw_window_cursor,
10519 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10520 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10524 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10525 void
10526 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10528 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10530 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10531 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10532 if (!terminal->name)
10533 return;
10535 BLOCK_INPUT;
10536 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10537 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10538 X display. */
10539 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10540 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10541 #endif
10543 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10544 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10545 if (dpyinfo->display)
10547 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10548 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10550 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10551 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10552 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10553 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10555 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10556 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10557 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10558 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10559 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10560 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10561 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10562 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10563 leaks in other situations. */
10564 #if 0
10565 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10566 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10567 #else
10568 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10569 #endif
10570 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10571 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10572 closing all the displays. */
10573 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10574 #endif
10576 #ifdef USE_GTK
10577 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10578 #else
10579 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10580 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10581 #else
10582 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10583 #endif
10584 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10587 /* Mark as dead. */
10588 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10589 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10590 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10593 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10594 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10596 static struct terminal *
10597 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10599 struct terminal *terminal;
10601 terminal = create_terminal ();
10603 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10604 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10605 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10607 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10609 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10610 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10611 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10612 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10613 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10614 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10615 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10616 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10617 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10618 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10619 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10620 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10621 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10622 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10623 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10624 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10625 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10626 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10627 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10628 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10630 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10631 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10633 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10634 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10635 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10636 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10637 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10638 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10639 off the bottom. */
10641 return terminal;
10644 void
10645 x_initialize (void)
10647 baud_rate = 19200;
10649 x_noop_count = 0;
10650 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10651 any_help_event_p = 0;
10652 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10654 #ifdef USE_GTK
10655 current_count = -1;
10656 #endif
10658 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10659 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10661 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10662 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10664 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10666 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10667 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10668 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10669 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10670 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10671 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10672 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10674 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10675 #endif
10677 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10678 #ifndef USE_GTK
10679 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10680 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10681 #endif
10682 #endif
10684 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10685 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10686 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10688 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10689 original error handler. */
10690 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10691 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10693 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10695 xgselect_initialize ();
10699 void
10700 syms_of_xterm (void)
10702 x_error_message = NULL;
10704 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10705 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10707 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10708 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10710 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10711 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10713 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10714 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10716 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10717 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10719 #ifdef USE_GTK
10720 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10721 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10723 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10724 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10725 #endif
10727 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10728 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10729 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10730 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10731 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10732 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10733 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10734 sizes. */);
10735 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10737 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10738 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10739 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10740 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10741 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10742 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10743 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10745 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10746 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10747 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10748 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10749 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10750 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10751 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10752 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10753 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10755 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10756 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10757 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10758 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10759 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10760 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10761 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10762 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10763 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10764 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10765 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10766 #elif USE_GTK
10767 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10768 #else
10769 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10770 #endif
10771 #else
10772 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10773 #endif
10775 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10776 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10778 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10779 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10780 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10781 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10782 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10783 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10784 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10785 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10786 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10788 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10789 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10790 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10791 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10792 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10793 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10795 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10796 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10797 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10798 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10799 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10800 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10802 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10803 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10804 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10805 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10806 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10807 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10809 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10810 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10811 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10812 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10813 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10814 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10816 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10817 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10818 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10819 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10820 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10821 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10824 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */